blob: 91630e8d749bf25c3b6bd52ec4db8beef7b66b99 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +000041 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000043 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
45 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
46 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
47 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000048 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
49 if (E.isInvalid())
50 return ExprError();
51 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000052}
53
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000054static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
55 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000056 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +000057 bool CStyle,
58 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000059
60static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
61 QualType &ToType,
62 bool InOverloadResolution,
63 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
64 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000065static OverloadingResult
66IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
67 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
68 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
69 bool AllowExplicit);
70
71
72static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
73CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
75 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
76
77static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
78CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
81
82static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
83CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
84 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
86
87
88
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000089/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
90/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000091ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000092GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
93 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
94 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
95 ICC_Identity,
96 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
97 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
98 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000099 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
101 ICC_Promotion,
102 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000103 ICC_Promotion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
109 ICC_Conversion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000113 ICC_Conversion,
114 ICC_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000115 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000116 ICC_Conversion
117 };
118 return Category[(int)Kind];
119}
120
121/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
122/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
123ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
124 static const ImplicitConversionRank
125 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
126 ICR_Exact_Match,
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
128 ICR_Exact_Match,
129 ICR_Exact_Match,
130 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000131 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000132 ICR_Promotion,
133 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000134 ICR_Promotion,
135 ICR_Conversion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
139 ICR_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000144 ICR_Conversion,
145 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000146 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000148 ICR_Conversion,
149 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 };
151 return Rank[(int)Kind];
152}
153
154/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
155/// implicit conversion.
156const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000157 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000158 "No conversion",
159 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
160 "Array-to-pointer",
161 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000162 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000163 "Qualification",
164 "Integral promotion",
165 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000166 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 "Integral conversion",
168 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000169 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000170 "Floating-integral conversion",
171 "Pointer conversion",
172 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000173 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000174 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000175 "Derived-to-base conversion",
176 "Vector conversion",
177 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000178 "Complex-real conversion",
179 "Block Pointer conversion",
180 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000181 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000182 };
183 return Name[Kind];
184}
185
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000186/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
187/// sequence to the identity conversion.
188void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
189 First = ICK_Identity;
190 Second = ICK_Identity;
191 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000192 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000193 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000194 ReferenceBinding = false;
195 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000196 IsLvalueReference = true;
197 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
198 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000199 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000200 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000201 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000202}
203
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000204/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
205/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
206/// implicit conversions.
207ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
208 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
209 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
210 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
211 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
212 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
213 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
214 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
215 return Rank;
216}
217
218/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
219/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000220/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000222bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000223 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
224 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
225 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
226 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000227 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000228 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
229 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
230 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000231 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000232 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
233 return true;
234
235 return false;
236}
237
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000238/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
239/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
240/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
241/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000242bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000243StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000244isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000245 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000246 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000247
248 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
249 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
250 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
251 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
252 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
253
Douglas Gregor5d3d3fa2011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000254 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000255 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000256 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
257
258 return false;
259}
260
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000261/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
262/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
263static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
264 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
265 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
266 case CK_NoOp:
267 case CK_IntegralCast:
268 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
269 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
270 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
271 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
272 case CK_FloatingCast:
273 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
274 continue;
275
276 default:
277 return Converted;
278 }
279 }
280
281 return Converted;
282}
283
284/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
285/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
286///
287/// \param Ctx The AST context.
288/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
289/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
290/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
291NarrowingKind
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000292StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
293 const Expr *Converted,
294 APValue &ConstantValue) const {
Richard Smith66e05fe2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000295 assert(Ctx.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
296
297 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
298 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
299 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
300 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
301 switch (Second) {
302 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
303 //
304 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
305 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
306 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
307 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
308 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
309 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
310 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
311 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
312 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
313 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
314 if (Initializer &&
315 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
316 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
317 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
318 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
319 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
320 // And back.
321 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
322 bool ignored;
323 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
324 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
325 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
326 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
327 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
328 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
329 }
330 } else {
331 // Variables are always narrowings.
332 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
333 }
334 }
335 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
336
337 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
338 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
339 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
340 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
341 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
342 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
343 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
344 // FromType is larger than ToType.
345 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
346 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
347 // Constant!
348 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
349 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
350 // Convert the source value into the target type.
351 bool ignored;
352 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
353 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
354 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
355 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
356 // values that can be represented.
357 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow)
358 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
359 } else {
360 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
361 }
362 }
363 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
364
365 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
366 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
367 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
368 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
369 // value when converted back to the original type.
370 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
371 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
372 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
373 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
374 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
375 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
376 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
377 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
378 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
379 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
380 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
381 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
382 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
383
384 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
385 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned)) {
386 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
387 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
388 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
389 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
390 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
391
392 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
393 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
394 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
395 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
396 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
397 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
398 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
399 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
400 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
401 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
402 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
403 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
404 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
405 } else {
406 // Variables are always narrowings.
407 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
408 }
409 }
410 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
411 }
412
413 default:
414 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
415 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 }
417}
418
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000419/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
420/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
421void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000422 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000423 bool PrintedSomething = false;
424 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000425 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000426 PrintedSomething = true;
427 }
428
429 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
430 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000431 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000432 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000433 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000434
435 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000436 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000437 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000438 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000439 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000440 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000441 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000442 PrintedSomething = true;
443 }
444
445 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
446 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000447 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000448 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000449 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000450 PrintedSomething = true;
451 }
452
453 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000455 }
456}
457
458/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
459/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
460void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000461 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000462 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
463 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000464 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000465 }
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000466 if (ConversionFunction)
467 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
468 else
469 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000470 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000471 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000472 After.DebugPrint();
473 }
474}
475
476/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
477/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
478void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000479 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 switch (ConversionKind) {
481 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 Standard.DebugPrint();
484 break;
485 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000486 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000487 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
488 break;
489 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000490 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000491 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000492 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000493 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000494 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000496 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 break;
498 }
499
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000500 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000501}
502
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000503void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
504 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
505}
506
507void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
508 conversions().~ConversionSet();
509}
510
511void
512AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
513 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
514 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
515 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
516}
517
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518namespace {
519 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
520 // template parameter and template argument information.
521 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
522 TemplateParameter Param;
523 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
524 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
525 };
526}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000527
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000528/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
529/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
530OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000531static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
532 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000533 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000534 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
535 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
536 Result.Data = 0;
537 switch (TDK) {
538 case Sema::TDK_Success:
539 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000540 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
541 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000542 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000543
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000544 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000545 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000546 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
547 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000548
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000549 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000550 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000551 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
552 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000553 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
554 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
555 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
556 Result.Data = Saved;
557 break;
558 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000559
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000560 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000561 Result.Data = Info.take();
562 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000563
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000565 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000566 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000567 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569 return Result;
570}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000571
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000572void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
573 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
574 case Sema::TDK_Success:
575 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
576 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000577 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
578 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000579 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000581
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000582 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000583 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000584 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000585 Data = 0;
586 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000587
588 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
589 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
590 Data = 0;
591 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000592
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000593 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000594 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000595 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
596 break;
597 }
598}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000599
600TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000601OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
602 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
603 case Sema::TDK_Success:
604 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000605 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
606 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000607 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000608 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000609
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000611 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000612 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000613
614 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000615 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000617
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000618 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000619 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000620 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
621 break;
622 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000623
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000624 return TemplateParameter();
625}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000626
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000627TemplateArgumentList *
628OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
629 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
630 case Sema::TDK_Success:
631 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
632 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
633 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
634 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
635 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
636 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000637 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000638 return 0;
639
640 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
641 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000642
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000643 // Unhandled
644 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
645 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
646 break;
647 }
648
649 return 0;
650}
651
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000652const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
653 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
654 case Sema::TDK_Success:
655 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
656 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000657 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
658 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000659 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000660 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661 return 0;
662
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000663 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000664 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000666
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000667 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000669 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
670 break;
671 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000672
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000674}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000675
676const TemplateArgument *
677OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
678 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
679 case Sema::TDK_Success:
680 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
681 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000682 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
683 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000685 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686 return 0;
687
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000688 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000689 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000690 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
691
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000692 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000693 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000694 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
695 break;
696 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000697
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000698 return 0;
699}
700
701void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Benjamin Kramer02b08432012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000702 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i)
703 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
704 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Benjamin Kramer0b9c5092012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000705 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000706 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000707 Functions.clear();
708}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000709
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000710namespace {
711 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
712 struct Entry {
713 Expr **Addr;
714 Expr *Saved;
715 };
716 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
717
718 public:
719 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
720 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
721 Entry entry = { &E, E };
722 Entries.push_back(entry);
723 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
724 }
725
726 void restore() {
727 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
728 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
729 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
730 }
731 };
732}
733
734/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
735/// preprocessing on the given expression.
736///
737/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
738/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
739///
740/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
741static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
742 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000743 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
744 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
745 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
746 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
747
748 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
749 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
750 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
751 unbridgedCasts) {
752 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
753 return false;
754 }
755
756 // Go ahead and check everything else.
757 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
758 if (result.isInvalid())
759 return true;
760
761 E = result.take();
762 return false;
763 }
764
765 // Nothing to do.
766 return false;
767}
768
769/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
770/// placeholders.
771static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
772 unsigned numArgs,
773 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
774 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
775 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
776 return true;
777
778 return false;
779}
780
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000781// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000782// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
783// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
784// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
785// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000786// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
787// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
788// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000789//
790// Example: Given the following input:
791//
792// void f(int, float); // #1
793// void f(int, int); // #2
794// int f(int, int); // #3
795//
796// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000797// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000798//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000799// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
800// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
801// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
802// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000803//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000804// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
805// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
806// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
807// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000808// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
809// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000810//
811// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
812// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
813// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
814// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000815Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000816Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
817 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000818 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000819 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000820 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
821
822 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
823 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
824 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
825
826 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
827 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
828 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
829
830 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
831 }
832
833 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
834 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
835 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
836 // function templates hide function templates with different
837 // return types or template parameter lists.
838 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
839 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
840
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000841 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000842 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
843 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
844 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
845 continue;
846 }
847
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000848 Match = *I;
849 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000850 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000851 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000852 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
853 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
854 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
855 continue;
856 }
857
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000858 Match = *I;
859 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000860 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000861 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000862 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
863 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
864 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000865 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
866 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000867 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
868 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
869 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
870 // template instantiation.
871 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000872 // (C++ 13p1):
873 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
874 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000875 Match = *I;
876 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000877 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000878 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000879
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000880 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000881}
882
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000883bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
884 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000885 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
886 // overloads.
887 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
888 return false;
889
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000890 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
891 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
892
893 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
894 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
895 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
896 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
897 return true;
898
899 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
900 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
901 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
902
903 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
904 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
905 // in the signature, they are overloads.
906
907 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
908 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
909 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
910 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
911 return false;
912
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000913 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
914 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000915
916 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
917 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
918 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
919 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
920 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
921 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000922 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000923 return true;
924
925 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
926 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
927 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
928 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
929 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
930 // signature.
931 //
932 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
933 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934 //
935 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
936 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
937 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000938 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
939 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
940 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
941 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
942 return true;
943
944 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000945 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000946 //
947 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
948 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
949 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
950 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
951 // can be overloaded.
952 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
953 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
954 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
955 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000956 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000957 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
958 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
959 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
960 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
961 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
962 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000963 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
964 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
965 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
966 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000967 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
968 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
969 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
970 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
971 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000972
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000973 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000974 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000975
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000976 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
977 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000978}
979
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +0000980/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
981/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
982///
983/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
984/// an available function, false otherwise.
985bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
986 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
987}
988
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +0000989/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
990///
991/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
992/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
993static ImplicitConversionSequence
994TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
995 bool SuppressUserConversions,
996 bool AllowExplicit,
997 bool InOverloadResolution,
998 bool CStyle,
999 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1000 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1001
1002 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1003 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1004 // we can perform.
1005 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1006 return ICS;
1007 }
1008
1009 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1010 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1011 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1012 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1013 AllowExplicit);
1014
1015 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1016 ICS.setUserDefined();
1017 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1018 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1019 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1020 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1021 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1022 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1023 // called for those cases.
1024 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1025 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1026 QualType FromCanon
1027 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1028 QualType ToCanon
1029 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1030 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1031 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1032 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1033 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1034 ICS.setStandard();
1035 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1036 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1037 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1038 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1039 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1040 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1041 }
1042 }
1043
1044 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1045 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1046 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1047 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1048 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1049 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1050 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1051 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1052 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1053 }
1054 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1055 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1056 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1057 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1058 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1059 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1060 if (Cand->Viable)
1061 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1062 } else {
1063 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1064 }
1065
1066 return ICS;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001069/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1070/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1071/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1072/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001073///
1074/// void f(float f);
1075/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1076///
1077/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1078/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1079/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1080/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1081//
1082/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1083/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1084/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1085/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1086/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001087///
1088/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1089/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001090/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1091/// permitted.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001092///
1093/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1094/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1095/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001096static ImplicitConversionSequence
1097TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1098 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001099 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001100 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001101 bool CStyle,
1102 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001103 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001104 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001105 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001106 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001107 return ICS;
1108 }
1109
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001110 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001111 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001112 return ICS;
1113 }
1114
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001115 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1116 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1117 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1118 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1119 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1120 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1121 // called for those cases.
1122 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1123 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001124 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1125 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001126 ICS.setStandard();
1127 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1128 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1129 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001130
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001131 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1132 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1133 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1134 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1135 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001136
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001137 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001138 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001139 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001140
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001141 return ICS;
1142 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001143
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001144 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1145 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1146 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001147}
1148
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001149ImplicitConversionSequence
1150Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1151 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1152 bool AllowExplicit,
1153 bool InOverloadResolution,
1154 bool CStyle,
1155 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1156 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1157 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1158 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1159 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160}
1161
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001162/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001163/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001164/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1165/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1166/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001167ExprResult
1168Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001169 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001170 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001171 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001172}
1173
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001174ExprResult
1175Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001176 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redlcc152642011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001177 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001178 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1179 return ExprError();
1180
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001181 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1182 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1183 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1184 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001185
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001186 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1187 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1188 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001189 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001190 /*CStyle=*/false,
1191 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001192 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1193}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194
1195/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001196/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001197bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1198 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001199 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1200 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001201
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001202 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1203 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1204 // - a pointer
1205 // - a member pointer
1206 // - a block pointer
1207 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1208 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1209 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1210 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1211 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1212 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1213 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1214 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1215 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1216 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1217 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1218 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1219 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1220 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1221 } else {
1222 return false;
1223 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001224
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001225 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1226 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1227 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1228 return false;
1229 }
1230
1231 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1232 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1233 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1234
1235 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1236 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1237 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1238
1239 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001240 return true;
1241}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001242
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001243/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1244/// vector conversion.
1245///
1246/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1247/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001248static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1249 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001250 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1251 // conversion.
1252 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1253 return false;
1254
1255 // Identical types require no conversions.
1256 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1257 return false;
1258
1259 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1260 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1261 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1262 // identity conversion.
1263 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1264 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001265
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001266 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001267 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001268 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1269 return true;
1270 }
1271 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001272
1273 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1274 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1275 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1276 // same size
1277 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1278 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001279 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1280 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001281 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1282 return true;
1283 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001284 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001285
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001286 return false;
1287}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001288
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001289/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1290/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1291/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1292/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1293/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1294/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1295/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1296/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001297static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1298 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001299 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 bool CStyle,
1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001302 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001303
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001304 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001305 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001306 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001307 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001308 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001309 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001310
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001311 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001312 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001313 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001314 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001315 return false;
1316
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001317 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001318 }
1319
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001320 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1321 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1322 // (C++ 4p1).
1323
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001324 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001325 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1326 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001327 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001328 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001329 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1330 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1331 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001332
1333 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1334 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1335 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1336 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1337 QualType resultTy;
1338 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001339 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001340 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1341 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1342 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1343 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001344 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001345
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001346 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1347 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1348 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1349 // expression.
1350 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1351 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1352 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1353 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1354 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1355 == UO_AddrOf &&
1356 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1357 const Type *ClassType
1358 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1359 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001360 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1361 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1362 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001363 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1364 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1365 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001366
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001367 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001368 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1369 FromType,
1370 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001371 } else {
1372 return false;
1373 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001374 }
John McCall154a2fd2011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001375 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1376 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1377 // be converted to a prvalue.
1378 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001379 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001380 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001381 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001382 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001383
1384 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1385 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001386 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1387 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001388 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001389 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1390 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001391 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001392
1393 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1394 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1395 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001396 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001397
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001398 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001399 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001400 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001401
1402 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1403 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1404 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1405 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001406 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1407 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001408 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001409 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001410 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001411 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001412 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001413 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001414 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001415
1416 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1417 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1418 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001419 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001420 } else {
1421 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001422 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001423 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001424 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425
1426 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1427 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1428 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1429 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001430 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1431 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001432 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001433 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001434 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001435 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1436 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001437 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001438 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001440 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001441 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001442 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001443 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001444 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001445 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001447 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001448 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1449 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001450 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1451 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1452 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1453 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1454 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1455 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1456 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1457 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1458 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001459 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001460 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001461 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001462 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001463 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001464 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001465 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001466 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1467 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001468 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1469 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001470 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1471 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1472 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001473 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001474 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1475 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1476 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001477 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001478 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001479 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001480 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001481 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001482 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001484 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001485 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1486 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1487 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1488 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001489 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1490 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001491 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001492 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001493 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001494 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001495 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001496 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001497 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001498 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001499 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001500 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001502 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1503 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001504 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001505 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001506 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001507 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001508 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1509 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001510 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1511 InOverloadResolution,
1512 SCS, CStyle)) {
1513 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1514 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001515 } else {
1516 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001517 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001518 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001519 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001520
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001521 QualType CanonFrom;
1522 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001523 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001524 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1525 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1526 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001527 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001528 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001529 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001530 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1531 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001532 } else {
1533 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001534 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1535
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001536 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001537 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1538 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1539 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001540 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1541 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001542 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001543 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001544 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001545 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1546 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001547 FromType = ToType;
1548 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1549 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001550 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001551 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001552
1553 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1554 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001555 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001556 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001557
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001558 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001559}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001560
1561static bool
1562IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1563 QualType &ToType,
1564 bool InOverloadResolution,
1565 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1566 bool CStyle) {
1567
1568 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1569 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1570 return false;
1571 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1572 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1573 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1574 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1575 itend = UD->field_end();
1576 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001577 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1578 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001579 ToType = it->getType();
1580 return true;
1581 }
1582 }
1583 return false;
1584}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585
1586/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1587/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1588/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1589/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001590bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001591 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001592 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001593 if (!To) {
1594 return false;
1595 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001596
1597 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1598 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1599 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1600 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1601 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001602 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1603 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001604 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1605 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1606 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1607 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001608 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001609 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001610 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001611 }
1612
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001613 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1614 }
1615
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001616 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1617 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1618 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1619 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1620 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1621 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001622 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001623 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001624 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001625 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1626 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001627 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001628 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1629 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1630 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1631 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1632 return false;
1633
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001634 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001635 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001636 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001637 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1638 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001639 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001640
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001641 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001642 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1643 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1644 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001645 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001646 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001647 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001648 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001649 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001650 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001651 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001652 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1653 // unsigned.
David Majnemerfa01a582011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001654 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001656
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001657 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1658 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001659 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1660 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001661 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1662 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001663 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001664 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001665 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1666 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001667 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001668 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1669 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1670 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1671 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001672 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001673 }
1674 }
1675 }
1676
1677 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1678 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1679 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1680 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1681 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1682 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1683 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001684 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1685 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001686 using llvm::APSInt;
1687 if (From)
1688 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001689 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001690 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001691 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1692 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1693 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001694
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001695 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1696 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1697 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1698 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1699 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001700
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001701 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1702 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1703 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1704 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1705 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001706
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001707 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001708 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001709 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001710
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001711 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1712 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001713 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001714 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001715 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001716
1717 return false;
1718}
1719
1720/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1721/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1722/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001723bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001724 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1725 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001726 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1727 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001728 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1729 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1730 return true;
1731
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001732 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1733 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1734 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1735 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1736 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1737 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1738 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1739 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001740
1741 // Half can be promoted to float.
1742 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1743 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1744 return true;
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001745 }
1746
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001747 return false;
1748}
1749
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001750/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1751///
1752/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1753/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001754/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001755bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001756 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001757 if (!FromComplex)
1758 return false;
1759
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001760 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001761 if (!ToComplex)
1762 return false;
1763
1764 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001765 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1766 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1767 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001768}
1769
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001770/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1771/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1772/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1773/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1774/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001775///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001776static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001777BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001778 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001779 ASTContext &Context,
1780 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001781 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1782 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1783 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001785 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1786 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001787 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001788
1789 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001790 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001791 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001792 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001793
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001794 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1795 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1796
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001797 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001798 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001799 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001800 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001801 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001802
1803 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1804 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001805 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1806 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001807 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1808 }
1809
1810 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001811 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1812 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001813
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001814 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1815 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1816 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001817}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001818
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001820 bool InOverloadResolution,
1821 ASTContext &Context) {
1822 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1823 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1824 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001825 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001826 return !InOverloadResolution;
1827
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001828 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1829 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1830 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001831}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001832
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001833/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1834/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1835/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1836/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1837/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1838/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001839///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001840/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1841/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1842/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1843/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1844/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1845/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001846/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1847/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1848/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001849bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001850 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001851 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001852 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001853 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001854 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1855 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001856 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001857
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1859 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001860 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001861 ConvertedType = ToType;
1862 return true;
1863 }
1864
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001865 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1866 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001867 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001868 ConvertedType = ToType;
1869 return true;
1870 }
1871 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1872 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001873 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001874 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001875 ConvertedType = ToType;
1876 return true;
1877 }
1878
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001879 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1880 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001881 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001882 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001883 ConvertedType = ToType;
1884 return true;
1885 }
1886
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001887 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001888 if (!ToTypePtr)
1889 return false;
1890
1891 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001892 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001893 ConvertedType = ToType;
1894 return true;
1895 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001896
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001897 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001898 // , including objective-c pointers.
1899 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001900 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1901 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001902 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1903 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1904 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001905 ToType, Context);
1906 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001907 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001908 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001909 if (!FromTypePtr)
1910 return false;
1911
1912 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001913
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001914 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001915 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1916 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1917 return false;
1918
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001919 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1920 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1921 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001922 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1923 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001924 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001925 ToPointeeType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001926 ToType, Context,
1927 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001928 return true;
1929 }
1930
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001931 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +00001932 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Pichetbc6ebb52011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001933 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1934 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1935 ToPointeeType,
1936 ToType, Context);
1937 return true;
1938 }
1939
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001940 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1941 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001942 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001943 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001945 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001946 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001947 return true;
1948 }
1949
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001950 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001951 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001952 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1953 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1954 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1955 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1956 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1957 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1958 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1959 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1960 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001961 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1962 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1964 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001965 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001966 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001967 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001968 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001969 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001970 ToType, Context);
1971 return true;
1972 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001973
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001974 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1975 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1976 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1977 ToPointeeType,
1978 ToType, Context);
1979 return true;
1980 }
1981
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001982 return false;
1983}
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001984
1985/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1986static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1987 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1988
1989 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1990 if (TQs == Qs)
1991 return T;
1992
1993 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1994 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1995
1996 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1997}
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001998
1999/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2000/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2001/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002002bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002003 QualType& ConvertedType,
2004 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2005 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2006 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002007
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002008 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2009 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2010
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002011 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002012 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2013 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002014 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002015 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002016
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002017 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002018 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2019 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2020 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2021 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2022 return false;
2023
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002024 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002025 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002026 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002027 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002028 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002029 return true;
2030 }
2031 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002033 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002035 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002036 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002037 return true;
2038 }
2039 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2040 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2041 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002042 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2043 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2044 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2045 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2046 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2047 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002048 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002049 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2050 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002051 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002052 return true;
2053 }
2054
2055 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2056 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2057 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2058 // complain about it.
2059 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002060 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002061 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2062 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002063 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002064 return true;
2065 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002067 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002068 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002069 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002070 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002071 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002072 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002073 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002074 // to a block pointer type.
2075 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002076 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002077 return true;
2078 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002079 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002080 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002081 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002082 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002083 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002084 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002085 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002086 return true;
2087 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002088 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002089 return false;
2090
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002091 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002092 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002093 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002094 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2095 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002096 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2097 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002098 return false;
2099
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002100 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2101 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2102 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2103 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2104 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2105 // We always complain about this conversion.
2106 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002107 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002108 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002109 return true;
2110 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002111 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2112 // as in I* to id.
2113 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2114 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2115 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2116 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002117
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002118 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002119 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002120 return true;
2121 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002122
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002123 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002124 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2125 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2126 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002127 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002128 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002129 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002130 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002131 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2132 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2133 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2134 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2135 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2136 return false;
2137
2138 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2139 // function types are obviously different.
2140 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2141 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2142 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2143 return false;
2144
2145 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2146 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2147 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2148 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2149 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2150 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2151 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2152 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2153 HasObjCConversion = true;
2154 } else {
2155 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2156 return false;
2157 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159 // Check argument types.
2160 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2161 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2162 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2163 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2164 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2165 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2166 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2167 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2168 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2169 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2170 HasObjCConversion = true;
2171 } else {
2172 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2173 return false;
2174 }
2175 }
2176
2177 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2178 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2179 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002180 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002181 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2182 return true;
2183 }
2184 }
2185
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002186 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002187}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002188
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002189/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2190/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2191///
2192/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2193///
2194/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2195///
2196/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2197/// this conversion.
2198bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2199 QualType &ConvertedType) {
2200 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2201 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2202 return false;
2203
2204 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2205 QualType ToPointee;
2206 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2207 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2208 else
2209 return false;
2210
2211 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2212 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2213 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2214 !ToQuals.withoutObjCGLifetime().empty())
2215 return false;
2216
2217 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2218 QualType FromPointee;
2219 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2220 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2221 else
2222 return false;
2223
2224 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2225 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2226 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2227 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2228 return false;
2229
2230 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2231 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2232 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2233 return false;
2234
2235 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2236 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2237 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2238 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2239
2240 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2241 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2242 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2243 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2244 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2245 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2246 IncompatibleObjC))
2247 return false;
2248
2249 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2250 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2251 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2252 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2253 return true;
2254}
2255
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002256bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2257 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2258 QualType ToPointeeType;
2259 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2260 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2261 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2262 else
2263 return false;
2264
2265 QualType FromPointeeType;
2266 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2267 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2268 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2269 else
2270 return false;
2271 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2272 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2273 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2274
2275 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2276 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2277 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2278 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2279
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002280 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2281 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002282
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002283 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002284 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002285
2286 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2287 // function types are obviously different.
2288 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2289 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2290 return false;
2291
2292 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2293 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2294 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2295 return false;
2296
2297 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002298 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2299 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002300 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2301 } else {
2302 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2303 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2304 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2305 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2306 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2307
2308 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2309 // OK exact match.
2310 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2311 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2312 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2313 return false;
2314 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2315 }
2316 else
2317 return false;
2318 }
2319
2320 // Check argument types.
2321 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2322 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2323 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2324 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2325 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2326 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2327 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2328 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2329 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2330 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2331 return false;
2332 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2333 } else
2334 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2335 return false;
2336 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002337 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2338 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2339 ToFunctionType))
2340 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian600ba202011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002341
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002342 ConvertedType = ToType;
2343 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002344}
2345
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002346enum {
2347 ft_default,
2348 ft_different_class,
2349 ft_parameter_arity,
2350 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2351 ft_return_type,
2352 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2353};
2354
2355/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2356/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2357/// parameter types, and different return types.
2358void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2359 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002360 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2361 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2362 PDiag << ft_default;
2363 return;
2364 }
2365
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002366 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2367 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2368 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2369 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2370 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2371 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2372 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2373 return;
2374 }
2375 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2376 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002377 }
2378
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002379 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2380 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2381 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2382 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2383
2384 // Remove references.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002385 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2386 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2387
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002388 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2389 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2390 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2391 PDiag << ft_default;
2392 return;
2393 }
2394
Richard Trieu96ed5b62011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002395 // No extra info for same types.
2396 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2397 PDiag << ft_default;
2398 return;
2399 }
2400
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002401 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2402 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2403
2404 // Both types need to be function types.
2405 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2406 PDiag << ft_default;
2407 return;
2408 }
2409
2410 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2411 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2412 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2413 return;
2414 }
2415
2416 // Handle different parameter types.
2417 unsigned ArgPos;
2418 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2419 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2420 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2421 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2422 return;
2423 }
2424
2425 // Handle different return type.
2426 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2427 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2428 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2429 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2430 return;
2431 }
2432
2433 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2434 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2435 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2436 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2437 return;
2438 }
2439
2440 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2441 PDiag << ft_default;
2442}
2443
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002444/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002445/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002446/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2447/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002448/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the the parameter index
2449/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002450bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002451 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2452 unsigned *ArgPos) {
2453 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1) {
2454 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2455 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2456 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2457 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2458 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2459 return false;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 return true;
2463 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002464
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002465 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2466 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2467 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2468 QualType ToType = (*O);
2469 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002470 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002471 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2472 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002473 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2474 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2475 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2476 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002477 continue;
2478 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002479 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2480 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002481 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002482 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2039ca02011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2484 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2485 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002486 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002487 }
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002488 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002489 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002490 }
2491 }
2492 return true;
2493}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002494
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002495/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2496/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002497/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002498/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2499/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2500/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002501bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002502 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002503 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002504 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002505 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002506 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002507
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002508 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2509
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002510 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2511 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2512 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2513 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002514 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2515 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002516
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002517 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2518 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002519 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2520 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002521
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002522 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2523 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002524 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2525 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002526 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2527 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002528 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002529 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002530 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002531
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002532 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002533 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002534 }
2535 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002536 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2537 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2538 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2539 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002540 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2541 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2542 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002543 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002544 return false;
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002545 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2546 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2547 } else {
2548 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002549 }
John McCall9320b872011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002550 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2551 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2552 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002553 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002554
2555 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2556 // reasons.
2557 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2558 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2559
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002560 return false;
2561}
2562
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002563/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2564/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2565/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2566/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2567/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2568bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002569 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002570 bool InOverloadResolution,
2571 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002572 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002573 if (!ToTypePtr)
2574 return false;
2575
2576 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002577 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2578 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2579 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002580 ConvertedType = ToType;
2581 return true;
2582 }
2583
2584 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002585 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002586 if (!FromTypePtr)
2587 return false;
2588
2589 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2590 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2591 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2592 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002593
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002594 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2595 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2596 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002597 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2598 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2599 return true;
2600 }
2601
2602 return false;
2603}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002604
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002605/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2606/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002607/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002608/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2609/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2610/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002611bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002612 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002613 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002614 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002615 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002616 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002617 if (!FromPtrType) {
2618 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002619 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002620 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002621 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002622 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002623 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002624 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002625
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002626 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002627 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2628 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002629
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002630 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2631 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002632
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002633 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2634 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2635 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002636
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002637 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002638 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002639 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2640 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2641 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2642 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002643
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002644 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2645 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002646 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2647 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2648 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2649 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002650 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002651
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002652 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002653 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2654 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2655 << From->getSourceRange();
2656 return true;
2657 }
2658
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002659 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002660 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2661 Paths.front(),
2662 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002663
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002664 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002665 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002666 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002667 return false;
2668}
2669
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002670/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2671/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2672/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002673///
2674/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2675/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2676/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002677bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002678Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002679 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002680 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2681 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002682 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2683
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002684 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2685 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002686 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002687 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002688
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002689 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2690 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2691 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2692 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002693 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002694 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002695 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2696 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2697 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002698 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002699 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2700 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002701 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002702
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002703 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2704 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2705
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002706 // Objective-C ARC:
2707 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2708 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2709 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2710 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2711 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2712 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2713 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2714 } else {
2715 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2716 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2717 return false;
2718 }
2719 }
2720
Douglas Gregorf30053d2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002721 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2722 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2723 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2724 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2725 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2726 }
2727
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002728 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2729 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002730 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002731 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002732
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002733 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2734 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002735 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002736 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002737 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002738
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002739 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2740 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002741 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor90609aa2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002742 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002744
2745 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2746 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2747 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2748 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2749 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002750 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002751}
2752
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002753/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2754/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2755/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2756/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2757/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2758/// false and User is unspecified.
2759///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002760/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2761/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2762/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002763static OverloadingResult
2764IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2765 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2766 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2767 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002768 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2769 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2770
2771 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2772 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002773 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002774 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2775 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2776 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2777 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2778 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2779 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2780 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2781 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002782 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002783 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002784 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002785 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2786
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7a6f2a32011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002787 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2788 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2789 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2790 // to try to recover.
2791 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002792 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2793 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2794 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002795
2796 Expr **Args = &From;
2797 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
2798 bool ListInitializing = false;
2799 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
2800 // arguments, not the entire list.
2801 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
2802 Args = InitList->getInits();
2803 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
2804 ListInitializing = true;
2805 }
2806
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002807 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002808 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002809 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002810 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2811 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2812
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002813 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2814 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2815 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002816 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002817 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002818 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002819 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2820 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002821 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002822
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002823 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
2824 if (ListInitializing)
2825 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2826 else
2827 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
2828 if (Usable) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002829 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002830 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2831 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002832 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002833 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002834 !ConstructorsOnly &&
2835 !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002836 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002837 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2838 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002839 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002840 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002841 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002842 !ConstructorsOnly && !ListInitializing);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002843 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002844 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002845 }
2846 }
2847
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002848 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002849 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002850 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2851 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002852 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002853 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002854 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002855 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002856 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2857 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002858 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002859 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002860 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002861 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002862 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2863 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002864 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2865 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2866 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2867
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002868 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2869 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002870 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2871 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002872 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002873 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002874
2875 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2876 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002877 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2878 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2879 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002880 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002881 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2882 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002883 }
2884 }
2885 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002886 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002887
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002888 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2889
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002890 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002891 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002892 case OR_Success:
2893 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2894 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2895 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002896 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2897
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002898 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2899 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2900 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2901 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2902 // the argument of the constructor.
2903 //
2904 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002905 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
2906 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2907 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2908 } else {
2909 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2910 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2911 else {
2912 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2913 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
2914 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002915 }
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002916 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002917 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002918 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002919 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2920 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2921 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2922 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00002923 }
2924 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002925 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002926 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2927
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002928 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2929 //
2930 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2931 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2932 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2933 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2934 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00002935 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002936 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00002937 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002938 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002939
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002940 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2941 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2942 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2943 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2944 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2945 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2946 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2947 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2948 // 13.3.3.1).
2949 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2950 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002951 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00002952 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002953
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002954 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2955 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2956 case OR_Deleted:
2957 // No conversion here! We're done.
2958 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002959
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002960 case OR_Ambiguous:
2961 return OR_Ambiguous;
2962 }
2963
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00002964 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002965}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002966
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002967bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002968Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002969 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002970 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002971 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002972 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002973 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002974 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2975 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2976 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2977 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2978 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2979 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2980 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2981 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2982 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002983 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002984 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002985 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002986}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002987
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002988/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2989/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2990/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002991static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2992CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2993 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2994 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002995{
2996 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2997 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2998 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2999 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3000 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3001 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3002 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3003 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003004 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003005 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3006 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3007 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3008 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3009 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003010 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3011 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003012 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003013 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003014
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003015 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3016 // the same kind.
3017 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3018 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3019
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003020 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3021 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3022
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003023 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3024 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3025 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003026 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003027 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3028 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003029 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003030 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3031 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3032 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3033 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3034 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3035 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003036 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003037 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003038 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3039 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3040 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003041 }
3042
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003043 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3044 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3045 // for some X and L2 does not.
3046 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
3047 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3048 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
3049 // FIXME: Find out if ICS1 converts to initializer_list and ICS2 doesn't.
3050 }
3051
3052 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003053}
3054
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003055static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3056 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3057 Qualifiers Quals;
3058 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003059 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003060 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003061
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003062 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3063}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003064
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003065// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3066// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3067static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3068compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3069 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3070 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3071 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3072 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3073
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003074 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003075 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor377c1092011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003076 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3077 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3078 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3079 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003080
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003081 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3082 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3083 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3084 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3085 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3086 else
3087 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003088 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003089 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3090
3091 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3092 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3093 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3094 }
3095
3096 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3097 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3098 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3099 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3100
3101 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3102 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3103 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3104 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003105
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003106 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3107}
3108
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003109/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3110/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3111static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3112 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3113 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3114 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3115 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003116 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003117 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003118 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003119 // reference*.
3120 //
3121 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3122 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3123 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3124 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3125 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003126 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3127 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3128 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003129
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003130 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3131 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3132 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3133 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3134}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003135
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003136/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3137/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3138/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003139static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3140CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3141 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3142 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003143{
3144 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3145 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3146
3147 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3148 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3149 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3150 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3151 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003152 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003153 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003154 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003155
3156 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3157 // defined below), or, if not that,
3158 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3159 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3160 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3161 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3162 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3163 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003164
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003165 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3166 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3167 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003168
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003169 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3170 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3171 // that is such a conversion.
3172 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3173 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3174 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3175 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3176
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003177 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3178 //
3179 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003180 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3181 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3182 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003183 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003184 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003185 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003186 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003187 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3188 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3189 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003190 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3191 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003192 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3193 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3194 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003195 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003196 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003197 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003198 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3199 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003200 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3201 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3202 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003203 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3204 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003205
3206 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3207 // conversion, if we need to.
3208 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003209 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003210 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003211 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003212
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003213 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3214 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003215
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003216 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003217 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003218 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003219 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3220
3221 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3222 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor30ee16f2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003223 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3224 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3225 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3226 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3227 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3228 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3229 FromObjCPtr2);
3230 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3231 FromObjCPtr1);
3232 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3233 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3234 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3235 }
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003236 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003237 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003238
3239 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3240 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003241 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003242 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003243 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003244
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003245 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003246 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3247 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3248 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3249 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3250 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003251
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003252 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3253 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3254 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3255 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3256 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3257 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003258 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3259 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003260 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3261 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003262 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003263 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3264 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003265 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003266 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3267 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3268 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3269 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3270 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3271 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3272 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3273 }
3274
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003275 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3276 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003277 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003278 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003279 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003280 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003281 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3282 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3283 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003284 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003285 }
3286 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003287
Francois Pichet08d2fa02011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003288 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3289 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3290 // is between types of the same size.
3291 // For example:
3292 // void f(float);
3293 // void f(int);
3294 // int main {
3295 // long a;
3296 // f(a);
3297 // }
3298 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3299 // as clang will do in standard mode.
3300 if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode &&
3301 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3302 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3303 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3304 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3305 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3306
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003307 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3308}
3309
3310/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3311/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003312/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3313ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003314CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3315 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3316 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003317 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003318 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3319 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3320 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3321 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3322 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3323 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3324 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3325 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3326
3327 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3328 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003329 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3330 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003331 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3332 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003333 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003334 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3335 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003336
3337 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3338 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003339 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003340 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3341
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003342 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3343 // for comparison.
3344 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003345 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003346 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003347 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003348
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003349 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003350 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003351
3352 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3353 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3354 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3355 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3356 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3357 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3358 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3359 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3360 }
3361
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003362 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003363 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3364 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3365 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003366 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003367 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3368 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3369 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3370 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3371 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3372 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3373 // about how the sequences rank.
3374 ;
3375 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3376 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3377 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3378 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3379 // qualifiers.
3380 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003381
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003382 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3383 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3384 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3385 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3386 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3387 // qualifiers.
3388 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003389
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003390 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3391 } else {
3392 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3394 }
3395
3396 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003397 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003398 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003399 }
3400
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003401 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3402 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3403 switch (Result) {
3404 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003405 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003406 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3407 break;
3408
3409 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3410 break;
3411
3412 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003413 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003414 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3415 break;
3416 }
3417
3418 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003419}
3420
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003421/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3422/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003423/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3424/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3425/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003426ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003427CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3428 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3429 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003430 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003431 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003432 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003433 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003434
3435 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3436 // conversion, if we need to.
3437 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003438 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003439 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003440 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003441
3442 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003443 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3444 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3445 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3446 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003447
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003448 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003449 //
3450 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3451 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003452 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003453 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003454 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003455 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3456 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3457 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3458 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003459 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003460 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003461 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003462 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003463 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003464 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003465 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003466 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003467
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003468 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003469 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003470 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003471 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003472 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003473 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3474 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003475
3476 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3477 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003478 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003479 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003480 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003481 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003482 }
3483 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3484 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3485 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3486 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3487 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3488 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3489 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3490 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3491 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3492 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3493
3494 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3495 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3496 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3497 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3498 // Objective-C pointer types.
3499 bool FromAssignLeft
3500 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3501 bool FromAssignRight
3502 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3503 bool ToAssignLeft
3504 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3505 bool ToAssignRight
3506 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3507
3508 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3509 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3510 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3511 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3512 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3513 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3514 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3515 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3516
3517 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3518 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3519 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3520 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3521 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3522 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3523
3524 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3525 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3526 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3527 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3528 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3529 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3530 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3531 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3532
3533 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3534 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3535 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3536 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3537 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3538 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003539
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003540 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3541 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3542 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3543 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3544 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3545 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3546
3547 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3548 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3549 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3550 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3551 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003552 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003553 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003554
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003555 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003556 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3557 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3558 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003559 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003560 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003561 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003562 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003563 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003564 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003565 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003566 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3567 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3568 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3569 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3570 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3571 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3572 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3573 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3574 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003575 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003576 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003577 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003578 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003579 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003580 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3581 }
3582 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3583 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003584 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003585 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003586 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003587 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3588 }
3589 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003590
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003591 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003592 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003593 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3594 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3595 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003596 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3597 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3598 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003599 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003600 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003601 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3602 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003603
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003604 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003605 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3606 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3607 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003608 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3609 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3610 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003611 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003612 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003613 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3614 }
3615 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003616
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003617 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3618}
3619
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003620/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3621/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3622/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3623/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3624/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3625/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3626/// type being initialized.
3627Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3628Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3629 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003630 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003631 bool &ObjCConversion,
3632 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003633 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3634 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3635 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3636
3637 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3638 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3639 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3640 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3641 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3642
3643 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3644 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3645 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3646 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003647 DerivedToBase = false;
3648 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003649 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003650 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3651 // Nothing to do.
3652 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003653 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3654 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003655 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3656 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3657 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3658 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003659 else
3660 return Ref_Incompatible;
3661
3662 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3663 // least).
3664
3665 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3666 // for comparison.
3667 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3668 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3669 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3670 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3671
3672 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3673 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3674 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3675 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3676 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3677 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3678 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003679 //
3680 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3681 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3682 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3683 // space 2.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003684 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3685 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3686 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3687 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3688 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3689 }
3690
Douglas Gregord517d552011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003691 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003692 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003693 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003694 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3695 else
3696 return Ref_Related;
3697}
3698
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003699/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003700/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3701static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003702FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3703 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3704 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3705 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003706 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3707 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3708 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3709
3710 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3711 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3712 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3713 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3714 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3715 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3716 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3717 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3718 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3719
3720 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3721 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3722 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3723 if (ConvTemplate)
3724 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3725 else
3726 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3727
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003728 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003729 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3730 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3731 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003732
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003733 if (AllowRvalues) {
3734 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3735 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003736 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00003737
3738 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
3739 // functions that return lvalues.
3740 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3741 const ReferenceType *RefType
3742 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
3743 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
3744 continue;
3745 }
3746
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003747 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003748 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3749 DeclLoc,
3750 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3751 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3752 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003753 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003754 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003755 continue;
3756 } else {
3757 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3758 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3759 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3760
3761 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3762 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3763 if (!RefType ||
3764 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3765 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3766 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003767 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003768
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003769 if (ConvTemplate)
3770 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003771 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003772 else
3773 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003774 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003775 }
3776
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003777 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3778
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003779 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003780 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003781 case OR_Success:
3782 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3783 //
3784 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3785 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3786 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3787 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3788 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3789 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3790 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3791 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3792 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3793 return false;
3794
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003795 if (Best->Function)
3796 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003797 ICS.setUserDefined();
3798 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3799 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003800 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003801 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003802 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003803 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3804 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3805 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3806 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3807 return true;
3808
3809 case OR_Ambiguous:
3810 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3811 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3812 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3813 if (Cand->Viable)
3814 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3815 return true;
3816
3817 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3818 case OR_Deleted:
3819 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3820 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3821 return false;
3822 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003823
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003824 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003825}
3826
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003827/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3828/// initialization.
3829static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00003830TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003831 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3832 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003833 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003834 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3835
3836 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3837 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3838 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3839
3840 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3841 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3842
3843 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3844 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3845 // type of the resulting function.
3846 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3847 DeclAccessPair Found;
3848 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3849 false, Found))
3850 T2 = Fn->getType();
3851 }
3852
3853 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3854 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3855 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003856 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003857 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003858 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003859 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003860 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003861 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003862
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003863
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003864 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003865 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3866 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3867
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003868 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003869 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003870 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3871 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3872 //
3873 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3874 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3875 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003876 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003877 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3878 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3879 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3880 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3881 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3882 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3883 ICS.setStandard();
3884 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003885 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3886 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3887 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003888 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3889 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3890 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3891 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3892 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3893 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3894 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003895 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3896 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3897 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003898 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003899 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003900 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003901
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003902 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3903 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3904 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3905 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003906 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003907 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003908
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003909 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3910 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3911 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3912 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3913 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3914 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3915 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3916 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003917 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003918 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003919 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3920 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3921 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003922 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003923 }
3924 }
3925
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003926 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3927 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003928 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003929 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003930 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3931 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3932 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3933 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3934 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3935 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3936 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003937 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3938 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003939 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003940 return ICS;
3941
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003942 // -- If the initializer expression
3943 //
3944 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003945 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003946 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3947 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3948 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3949 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3950 ICS.setStandard();
3951 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003952 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003953 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3954 : ICK_Identity;
3955 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3956 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3957 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3958 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3959 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3960 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3961 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3962 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3963 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3964 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3965 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003966 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3967 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003968 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003969 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3970 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003971 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003972 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003973 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003974 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003975 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003976 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003977
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003978 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3979 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003980 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3981 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003982 // "cv3 T3",
3983 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003984 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003985 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003986 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003987 // class subobject).
3988 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003989 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003990 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3991 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3992 AllowExplicit)) {
3993 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3994 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3995 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3996 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003997 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003998 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3999 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4000
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004001 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004002 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004003
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004004 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4005 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4006 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4007 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4008 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4009 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4010 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4011 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4012 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4013 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4014 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4015 // initialization fails.
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004016 //
4017 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4018 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4019 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4020 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4021 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4022 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4023 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4024 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4025 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4026 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004027 }
4028
4029 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4030 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4031 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4032 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4033 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4034 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4035 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4036 return ICS;
4037
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004038 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4039 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4040 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4041 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4042 return ICS;
4043
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004044 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004045 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4046 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4047 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4048 // underlying type of the reference according to
4049 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4050 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4051 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4052 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4053 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004054 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4055 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004056 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004057 /*CStyle=*/false,
4058 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004059
4060 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4061 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4062 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004063 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4064 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4065 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004066 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004067 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004068 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregorb0e6c8a2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004069 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4070 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4071 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4072 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4073 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4074 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4075 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4076 DeclType);
4077 return ICS;
4078 }
4079 }
4080 }
4081
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004082 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor3ec79102011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004083 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4084 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4085 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4086 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4087 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004088 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004089
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004090 return ICS;
4091}
4092
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004093static ImplicitConversionSequence
4094TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4095 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4096 bool InOverloadResolution,
4097 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4098
4099/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4100/// initializer list From.
4101static ImplicitConversionSequence
4102TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4103 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4104 bool InOverloadResolution,
4105 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4106 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4107 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4108 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4109
4110 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4111 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004112 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004113
Sebastian Redl09edce02012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004114 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004115 // initialized from init lists.
4116 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag()))
4117 return Result;
4118
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004119 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4120 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4121 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4122 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4123 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004124 QualType X;
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004125 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004126 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType);
4127 else
4128 (void)S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
4129 if (!X.isNull()) {
4130 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4131 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4132 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4133 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4134 InOverloadResolution,
4135 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4136 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4137 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4138 Result = ICS;
4139 break;
4140 }
4141 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4142 if (Result.isBad() ||
4143 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4144 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4145 Result = ICS;
4146 }
4147 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004148 return Result;
Sebastian Redl10f0fc02012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004149 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004150
4151 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4152 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4153 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4154 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4155 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4156 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004157 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4158 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4159 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4160 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4161 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4162 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4163 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004164 return Result;
Sebastian Redl6901c0d2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004165 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004166
4167 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4168 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4169 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4170 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004171 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redl72ef7bc2011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004172 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4173 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4174 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4175 InitializedEntity Entity =
4176 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4177 /*Consumed=*/false);
4178 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4179 Result.setUserDefined();
4180 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4181 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4182 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4183 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4184
4185 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4186 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4187 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4188 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004189 return Result;
4190 }
4191
4192 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4193 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004194 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4195 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4196 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4197 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4198
4199 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4200
4201 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4202 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4203 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4204 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4205
4206 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4207
4208 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4209 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4210 // type of the resulting function.
4211 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4212 DeclAccessPair Found;
4213 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4214 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4215 T2 = Fn->getType();
4216 }
4217
4218 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4219 bool dummy1 = false;
4220 bool dummy2 = false;
4221 bool dummy3 = false;
4222 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4223 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4224 dummy2, dummy3);
4225
4226 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4227 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4228 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4229 SuppressUserConversions,
4230 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4231 }
4232
4233 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4234 // initializer list.
4235 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4236 InOverloadResolution,
4237 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4238 if (Result.isFailure())
4239 return Result;
4240 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4241 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4242
4243 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4244 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4245 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4246 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4247 Result.UserDefined.After;
4248 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4249 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4250 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4251 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4252 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4253 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4254 } else
4255 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4256 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004257 return Result;
Sebastian Redldf888642011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004258 }
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004259
4260 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4261 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4262 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4263 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4264 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4265 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004266 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4267 if (NumInits == 1)
4268 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4269 SuppressUserConversions,
4270 InOverloadResolution,
4271 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4272 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4273 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4274 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4275 Result.setStandard();
4276 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4277 }
4278 return Result;
4279 }
4280
4281 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4282 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4283 return Result;
4284}
4285
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004286/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4287/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4288/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4289/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004290/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004291/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004292static ImplicitConversionSequence
4293TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004294 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004295 bool InOverloadResolution,
4296 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Sebastian Redlb17be8d2011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004297 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4298 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4299 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4300
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004301 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004302 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004303 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4304 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004305 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004306
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004307 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4308 SuppressUserConversions,
4309 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004310 InOverloadResolution,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004311 /*CStyle=*/false,
4312 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004313}
4314
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004315static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4316 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4317 Sema &S,
4318 SourceLocation Loc,
4319 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4320 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4321 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4322 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4323
4324 return !ICS.isBad();
4325}
4326
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004327/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4328/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4329/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004330static ImplicitConversionSequence
4331TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004332 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004333 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4334 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4335 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004336 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4337 // const volatile object.
4338 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4339 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004340 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004341
4342 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4343 // to exit early.
4344 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004345
4346 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00004347 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004348 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004349 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4350
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004351 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4352 // better have an lvalue.
4353 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4354 }
4355
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004356 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004357
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004358 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004359 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004360 // parameter is
4361 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004362 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4363 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4364 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004365 // ref-qualifier
4366 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004367 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004368 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4369 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004370 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004371 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004372 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4373 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4374 // non-constant references.
4375
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004376 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004377 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004378 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004379 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004380 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004381 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4382 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004383 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004384 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004385
4386 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4387 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004388 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004389 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4390 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4391 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004392 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004393 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004394 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004395 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4396 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004397 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004398 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004399
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004400 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4401 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4402 case RQ_None:
4403 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4404 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004405
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004406 case RQ_LValue:
4407 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4408 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004409 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004410 ImplicitParamType);
4411 return ICS;
4412 }
4413 break;
4414
4415 case RQ_RValue:
4416 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4417 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004418 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004419 ImplicitParamType);
4420 return ICS;
4421 }
4422 break;
4423 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004424
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004425 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004426 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004427 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4428 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004429 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004430 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004431 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4432 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004433 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004434 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004435 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4436 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4437 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004438 return ICS;
4439}
4440
4441/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4442/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4443/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004444ExprResult
4445Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004446 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004447 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004448 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004449 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004450 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004451 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004452
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004453 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004454 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004455 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4456 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004457 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004458 } else {
4459 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4460 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004461 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004462 }
4463
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004464 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4465 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004466 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004467 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4468 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004469 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4470 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4471 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4472 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4473 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4474 if (CVR) {
4475 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4476 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4477 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4478 << From->getSourceRange();
4479 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4480 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004481 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004482 }
4483 }
4484
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004485 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004486 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004487 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004489
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004490 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4491 ExprResult FromRes =
4492 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4493 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4494 return ExprError();
4495 From = FromRes.take();
4496 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004497
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004498 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004499 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smith4a905b62011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004500 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004501 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004502}
4503
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004504/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4505/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004506static ImplicitConversionSequence
4507TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004508 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004509 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004510 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4511 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004512 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004513 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004514 /*CStyle=*/false,
4515 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004516}
4517
4518/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4519/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004520ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004521 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4522 return ExprError();
4523
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004524 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004525 if (!ICS.isBad())
4526 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004527
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004528 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004529 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4530 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004531 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004532 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004533}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004534
Richard Smithf8379a02012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004535/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4536/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4537/// is acceptable.
4538static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4539 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4540 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4541 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4542 // conversions are fine.
4543 switch (SCS.Second) {
4544 case ICK_Identity:
4545 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4546 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4547 return true;
4548
4549 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
4550 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4551 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4552 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4553 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4554 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4555
4556 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4557 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4558 return false;
4559
4560 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4561 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4562 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4563 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4564 case ICK_Qualification:
4565 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4566 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4567 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4568 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4569 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4570 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4571 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4572 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4573 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4574 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4575 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4576 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4577 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4578 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4579
4580 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4581 break;
4582 }
4583
4584 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4585}
4586
4587/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4588/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4589/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4590ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4591 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4592 CCEKind CCE) {
4593 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
4594 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4595
4596 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4597 return ExprError();
4598
4599 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4600 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4601 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4602 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4603 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4604 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4605 // narrowing conversions.
4606 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4607 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4608 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4609 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4610 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4611 /*CStyle=*/false,
4612 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4613 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4614 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4615 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4616 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
4617 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4618 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4619 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4620 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4621 break;
4622 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4623 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4624 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4625 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
4626 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4627 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4628 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4629 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4630 break;
4631 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4632 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4633 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
4634 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4635 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4636 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4637 return ExprError();
4638
4639 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4640 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4641 }
4642
4643 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4644 if (Result.isInvalid())
4645 return Result;
4646
4647 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4648 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
4649 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue)) {
4650 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4651 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4652 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4653 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4654 break;
4655
4656 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
4657 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4658 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
4659 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, QualType()) << T;
4660 break;
4661
4662 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
4663 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_cce_narrowing)
4664 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
4665 break;
4666 }
4667
4668 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
4669 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
4670 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
4671 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
4672
4673 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
4674 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
4675 // the AST.
4676 Result = ExprError();
4677 } else if (Notes.empty()) {
4678 // It's a constant expression.
4679 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
4680 return Result;
4681 }
4682
4683 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
4684 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
4685 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
4686 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
4687 else {
4688 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
4689 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
4690 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
4691 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
4692 }
4693 return ExprError();
4694}
4695
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004696/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
4697/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
4698/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
4699static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4700 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4701 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
4702 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
4703 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
4704 }
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004705}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004706
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004707/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
4708/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4709static ImplicitConversionSequence
4710TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4711 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
4712 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
4713 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4714 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
4715 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4716 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4717 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4718 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4719 /*CStyle=*/false,
4720 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4721
4722 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
4723 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4724 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4725 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4726 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4727 break;
4728
4729 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4730 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
4731 break;
4732
4733 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4734 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
4735 break;
4736 }
4737
4738 return ICS;
4739}
4740
4741/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
4742/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4743ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004744 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4745 return ExprError();
4746
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004747 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCallfec112d2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004748 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4749 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004750 if (!ICS.isBad())
4751 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004752 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004753}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004754
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004755/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004756/// enumeration type.
4757///
4758/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
4759/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
4760/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4761///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004762/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
4763/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004764///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004765/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
4766///
4767/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
4768/// have integral or enumeration type.
4769///
4770/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
4771/// incomplete class type.
4772///
4773/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
4774/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
4775/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
4776///
4777/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
4778/// showing which conversion was picked.
4779///
4780/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
4781/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
4782///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004783/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004784/// usable conversion function.
4785///
4786/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
4787/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
4788///
4789/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
4790/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004791ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004792Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004793 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
4794 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
4795 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
4796 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
4797 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004798 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
4799 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004800 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
4801 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004802 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004803
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004804 // Process placeholders immediately.
4805 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
4806 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
4807 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
4808 From = result.take();
4809 }
4810
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004811 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
4812 QualType T = From->getType();
4813 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004814 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004815
4816 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
4817
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004818 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004819 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
4820 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4821 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4822 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4823 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004824 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004825 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004826
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004827 // We must have a complete class type.
4828 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004829 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004830
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004831 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4832 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
4833 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
4834 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4835 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004836
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004837 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1);
4838
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004839 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004840 E = Conversions->end();
4841 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004842 ++I) {
4843 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4844 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
4845 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4846 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
4847 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
4848 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4849 else
4850 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4851 }
4852 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004853
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004854 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
4855 case 0:
4856 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
4857 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
4858 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4859 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004860
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004861 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
4862 // conversion; use it.
4863 QualType ConvTy
4864 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4865 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor75acd922011-09-27 23:30:47 +00004866 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004867
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004868 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
4869 << T << ConvTy
4870 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
4871 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
4872 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
4873 ")");
4874 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
4875 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004876
4877 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004878 // explicit conversion function.
4879 if (isSFINAEContext())
4880 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004881
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004882 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004883 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
4884 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004885 if (Result.isInvalid())
4886 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00004887 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
4888 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
4889 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
4890 Result.get(), 0,
4891 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004892 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004893
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004894 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
4895 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004896
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004897 case 1: {
4898 // Apply this conversion.
4899 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
4900 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004901
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004902 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4903 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
4904 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004905 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004906 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
4907 if (isSFINAEContext())
4908 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004909
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004910 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
4911 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
4912 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004913
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004914 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
4915 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004916 if (Result.isInvalid())
4917 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +00004918 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
4919 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
4920 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
4921 Result.get(), 0,
4922 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004923 break;
4924 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004925
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004926 default:
4927 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
4928 << T << From->getSourceRange();
4929 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
4930 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
4931 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
4932 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4933 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
4934 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
4935 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004936 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004937 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004938
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00004939 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004940 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4941 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004942
Eli Friedman1da70392012-01-26 00:26:18 +00004943 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004944}
4945
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004946/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004947/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
4948/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
4949/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004950///
4951/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
4952/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
4953/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004954void
4955Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004956 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004957 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004958 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00004959 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004960 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004961 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004962 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004963 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004964 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004965 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004966
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004967 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004968 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
4969 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
4970 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
4971 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
4972 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004973 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
4974 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
4975 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004976 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004977 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004978 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004979 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004980 return;
4981 }
4982 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
4983 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004984 }
4985
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00004986 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004987 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004988
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004989 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004990 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004991
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004992 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
4993 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
4994 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
4995 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
4996 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004997 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00004998 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00004999 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5000 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005001 return;
5002 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005003
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005004 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005005 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005006 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005007 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005008 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005009 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005010 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005011 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005012
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005013 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5014
5015 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5016 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5017 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005018 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005019 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005020 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005021 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005022 return;
5023 }
5024
5025 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5026 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5027 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5028 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5029 // exactly m parameters.
5030 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005031 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005032 // Not enough arguments.
5033 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005034 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005035 return;
5036 }
5037
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005038 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
5039 if (getLangOptions().CUDA)
5040 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5041 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5042 Candidate.Viable = false;
5043 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5044 return;
5045 }
5046
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005047 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5048 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005049 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5050 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5051 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5052 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5053 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5054 // parameter of F.
5055 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005056 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005057 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005058 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005059 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5060 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5061 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005062 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5063 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005064 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005065 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005066 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005067 } else {
5068 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5069 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5070 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005071 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005072 }
5073 }
5074}
5075
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005076/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5077/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005078void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005079 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5080 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5081 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005082 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005083 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5084 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005085 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005086 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005087 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005088 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005089 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005090 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
5091 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005092 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005093 SuppressUserConversions);
5094 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005095 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005096 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5097 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005098 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005099 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005100 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005101 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005102 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
5103 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005104 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005105 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005106 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005107 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005108 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005109 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
5110 SuppressUserConversions);
5111 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005112 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005113}
5114
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005115/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5116/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005117void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005118 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005119 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005120 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5121 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005122 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005123 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005124 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005125
5126 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5127 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005128
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005129 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5130 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5131 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005132 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5133 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005134 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005135 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005136 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005137 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005138 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005139 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005140 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005141 }
5142}
5143
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005144/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5145/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5146/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5147/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5148/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5149/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005150/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005151void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005152Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005153 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005154 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005155 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005156 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005157 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005158 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005159 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005160 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005161 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5162 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005163
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005164 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5165 return;
5166
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005167 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005168 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005169
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005170 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005171 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005172 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005173 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005174 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005175 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005176 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005177
5178 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5179
5180 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5181 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5182 // list (8.3.5).
5183 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5184 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005185 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005186 return;
5187 }
5188
5189 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5190 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5191 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5192 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5193 // exactly m parameters.
5194 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
5195 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
5196 // Not enough arguments.
5197 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005198 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005199 return;
5200 }
5201
5202 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005203
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005204 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005205 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5206 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5207 else {
5208 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5209 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005210 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005211 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5212 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005213 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005214 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005215 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005216 return;
5217 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005218 }
5219
5220 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5221 // arguments.
5222 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5223 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5224 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5225 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5226 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5227 // parameter of F.
5228 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005229 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005230 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005231 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005232 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5233 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5234 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005235 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005236 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005237 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005238 break;
5239 }
5240 } else {
5241 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5242 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5243 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005244 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005245 }
5246 }
5247}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005248
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005249/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5250/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5251/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005252void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005253Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005254 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005255 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005256 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005257 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005258 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005259 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005260 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005261 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005262 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5263 return;
5264
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005265 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005266 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005267 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005268 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005269 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5270 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5271 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5272 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5273 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005274 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005275 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5276 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005277 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005278 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005279 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005280 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5281 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5282 Candidate.Viable = false;
5283 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5284 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5285 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005286 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005287 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005288 Info);
5289 return;
5290 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005292 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5293 // deduction as a candidate.
5294 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005295 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005296 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005297 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005298 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5299 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005300}
5301
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005302/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5303/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5304/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005305void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005306Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005307 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005308 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005309 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5310 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005311 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005312 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5313 return;
5314
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005315 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005316 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005317 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005318 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005319 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5320 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5321 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5322 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5323 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005324 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005325 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5326 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005327 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00005328 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005329 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005330 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005331 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5332 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005333 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005334 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5335 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005336 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005337 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005338 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005339 return;
5340 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005341
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005342 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5343 // deduction as a candidate.
5344 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005345 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005346 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005347}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005348
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005349/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005350/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005351/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005352/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005353/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5354/// conversion function produces).
5355void
5356Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005357 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005358 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005359 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5360 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005361 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5362 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005363 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005364 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5365 return;
5366
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005367 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005368 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005369
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005370 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005371 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005372 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005373 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005374 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005375 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005376 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005377 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005378 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005379 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005380 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005381
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005382 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005383 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5384 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005385 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005386 //
5387 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5388 // object parameter.
5389 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5390 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5391 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5392 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5393 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005394
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005395 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005396 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5397 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005398 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005399
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005400 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005401 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005402 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005403 return;
5404 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005405
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005406 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005407 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5408 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5409 QualType FromCanon
5410 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5411 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5412 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5413 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005414 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005415 return;
5416 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005417
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005418 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5419 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5420 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5421 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5422 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5423 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5424 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5425 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005426 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005427 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005428 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5429 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005430 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005431 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005432
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005433 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5434 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005435 Candidate.Viable = false;
5436 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5437 return;
5438 }
5439
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005440 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005441
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005442 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005443 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5444 // allocator).
Richard Smith48d24642011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005445 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005446 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005447 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005448 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005449 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005450 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005451 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5452 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005453
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005454 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005455 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5456 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005457
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005458 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5459 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005460 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005461 // shall have exact match rank.
5462 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5463 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5464 Candidate.Viable = false;
5465 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5466 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005467
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005468 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5469 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5470 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5471 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5472 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005473 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005474 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5475 Candidate.Viable = false;
5476 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5477 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005478 break;
5479
5480 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5481 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005482 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005483 break;
5484
5485 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005486 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005487 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5488 }
5489}
5490
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005491/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5492/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5493/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5494/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5495/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005496void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005497Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005498 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005499 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005500 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5501 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5502 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5503 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5504
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005505 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5506 return;
5507
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005508 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005509 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5510 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005511 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005512 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005513 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005514 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5515 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5516 Candidate.Viable = false;
5517 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5518 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5519 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005520 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005521 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005522 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005523 return;
5524 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005525
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005526 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5527 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5528 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005529 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005530 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005531}
5532
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005533/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5534/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5535/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5536/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5537/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5538void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005539 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005540 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005541 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005542 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005543 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005544 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005545 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5546 return;
5547
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005548 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005549 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005550
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005551 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs + 1);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005552 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005553 Candidate.Function = 0;
5554 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5555 Candidate.Viable = true;
5556 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005557 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005558 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005559
5560 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5561 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005562 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005563 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005564 Object->Classify(Context),
5565 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005566 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005567 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005568 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005569 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005570 return;
5571 }
5572
5573 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5574 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5575 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005576 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005577 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005578 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005579 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005580 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCall30909032011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005581 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005582 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005583 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5584 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5585
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005586 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005587 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5588
5589 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5590 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5591 // list (8.3.5).
5592 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5593 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005594 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005595 return;
5596 }
5597
5598 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5599 // we have enough arguments.
5600 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
5601 // Not enough arguments.
5602 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005603 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005604 return;
5605 }
5606
5607 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5608 // arguments.
5609 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5610 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5611 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5612 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5613 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5614 // parameter of F.
5615 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005616 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005617 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005618 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005619 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5620 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5621 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005622 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005623 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005624 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005625 break;
5626 }
5627 } else {
5628 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5629 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5630 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005631 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005632 }
5633 }
5634}
5635
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005636/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5637/// member functions.
5638///
5639/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5640/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5641/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5642/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5643/// [over.match.oper]).
5644void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5645 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5646 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5647 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5648 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005649 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5650
5651 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5652 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5653 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5654 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5655 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5656 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5657 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5658 // constructed as follows:
5659 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005660
5661 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5662 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5663 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
5664 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005665 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005666 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00005667 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005668 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005669
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00005670 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
5671 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
5672 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
5673
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005674 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005675 OperEnd = Operators.end();
5676 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005677 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005678 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005679 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005680 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005681 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005682 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005683}
5684
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005685/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
5686/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
5687/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005688/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
5689/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005690/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
5691/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
5692/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005693void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005694 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005695 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005696 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
5697 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005698 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005699 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005700
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005701 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramerfb761ff2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005702 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005703 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005704 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00005705 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005706 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005707 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
5708 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5709 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
5710
5711 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5712 // arguments.
5713 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005714 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005715 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005716 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
5717 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
5718 // left operand are restricted as follows:
5719 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
5720 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
5721 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005722 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005723 //
5724 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
5725 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
5726 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
5727 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005728 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005730 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005731 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5732 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005733 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005734 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005735 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005736 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005737 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5738 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5739 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005740 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005741 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005742 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005743 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005744 break;
5745 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005746 }
5747}
5748
5749/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
5750/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
5751/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
5752/// enumeration types.
5753class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
5754 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005755 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005756
5757 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
5758 /// built-in candidates.
5759 TypeSet PointerTypes;
5760
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005761 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
5762 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5763 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
5764
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005765 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
5766 /// used in the built-in candidates.
5767 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
5768
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005769 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005770 /// candidates.
5771 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005772
5773 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
5774 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
5775
5776 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
5777 /// were present in the candidate set.
5778 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
5779
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005780 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
5781 /// candidate set.
5782 bool HasNullPtrType;
5783
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00005784 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
5785 /// candidate type set.
5786 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005787
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005788 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
5789 ASTContext &Context;
5790
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005791 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5792 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005793 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005794
5795public:
5796 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005797 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005798
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005799 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005800 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
5801 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005802 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005803 SemaRef(SemaRef),
5804 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005805
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005806 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005807 SourceLocation Loc,
5808 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005809 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5810 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005811
5812 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
5813 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
5814
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005815 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005816 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
5817
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005818 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
5819 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
5820
5821 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
5822 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
5823
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005824 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
5825 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
5826
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005827 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005828 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005829
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005830 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
5831 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005832
5833 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
5834 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005835 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005836};
5837
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005838/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005839/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5840/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5841/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5842/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5843/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5844/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005845///
5846/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005847bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005848BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5849 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005850
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005851 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005852 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005853 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005854
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005855 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005856 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005857 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005858 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005859 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005860 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005861 buildObjCPtr = true;
5862 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005863 else
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005864 llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005865 }
5866 else
5867 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005868
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00005869 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5870 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5871 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5872 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5873 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5874 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005875 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00005876 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00005877 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005878 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
5879 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005880
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005881 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
5882 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5883 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005884 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
5885 // in the types.
5886 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
5887 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005888 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00005889 if (!buildObjCPtr)
5890 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
5891 else
5892 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005893 }
5894
5895 return true;
5896}
5897
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005898/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
5899/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5900/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5901/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5902/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5903/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5904/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005905///
5906/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005907bool
5908BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
5909 QualType Ty) {
5910 // Insert this type.
5911 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
5912 return false;
5913
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005914 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5915 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005916
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005917 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00005918 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5919 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5920 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5921 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5922 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5923 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005924 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
5925
5926 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
5927 // qualifiers.
5928 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
5929 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5930 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005931
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005932 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005933 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
5934 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005935 }
5936
5937 return true;
5938}
5939
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005940/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
5941/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005942/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
5943/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005944/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
5945/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
5946/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
5947/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005948void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005949BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005950 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005951 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005952 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5953 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005954 // Only deal with canonical types.
5955 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
5956
5957 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
5958 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005959 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005960 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
5961
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005962 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
5963 if (Ty->isArrayType())
5964 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
5965
5966 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005967 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005968
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005969 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
5970 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
5971 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
5972
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005973 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
5974 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
5975 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
5976
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005977 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
5978 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
5979 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005980 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
5981 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005982 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005983 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005984 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
5985 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
5986 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
5987 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005988 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005989 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005990 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005991 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005992 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
5993 // extension.
5994 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005995 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005996 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
5997 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005998 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
5999 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6000 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6001 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006002
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006003 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6004 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
6005 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6006 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
6007 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
6008 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6009 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6010 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006011
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006012 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6013 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6014 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6015 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006016
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006017 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6018 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6019 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6020 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006021 }
6022 }
6023 }
6024}
6025
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006026/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6027/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6028/// given type to the candidate set.
6029static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6030 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006031 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006032 unsigned NumArgs,
6033 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6034 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006035
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006036 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6037 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6038 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6039 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6040 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006041
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006042 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6043 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006044 ParamTypes[0]
6045 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006046 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6047 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006048 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006049 }
6050}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006051
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006052/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6053/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006054static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6055 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6056 const RecordType *TyRec;
6057 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6058 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006059 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006060 else
6061 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6062 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006063 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006064 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6065 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6066 return VRQuals;
6067 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006068
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006069 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006070 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6071 return VRQuals;
6072
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006073 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006074 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006075
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006076 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006077 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006078 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6079 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6080 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6081 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006082 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6083 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6084 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6085 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6086 // as see them.
6087 bool done = false;
6088 while (!done) {
6089 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6090 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006091 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006092 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6093 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6094 else
6095 done = true;
6096 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6097 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6098 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6099 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6100 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6101 return VRQuals;
6102 }
6103 }
6104 }
6105 return VRQuals;
6106}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006107
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006108namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006109
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006110/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6111/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6112/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6113/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6114class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006115 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6116 Sema &S;
6117 Expr **Args;
6118 unsigned NumArgs;
6119 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006120 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006121 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006122 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006123
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006124 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6125 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006126 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6127 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006128 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
6129 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
6130 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
6131 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
6132 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
6133 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
6134 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
6135
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006136 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6137 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6138 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6139 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6140 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6141 // Start of promoted types.
6142 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6143 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6144 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006145
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006146 // Start of integral types.
6147 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6148 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6149 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
6150 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6151 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6152 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
6153 // End of promoted types.
6154
6155 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6156 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6157 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6158 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6159 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6160 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6161 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6162 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6163 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6164 // End of integral types.
6165 // FIXME: What about complex?
6166 };
6167 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6168 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006169
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006170 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6171 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6172 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6173 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6174 // The rules are basically:
6175 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6176 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6177 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6178 // - use the larger type
6179 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6180 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6181 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6182 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6183 // better not to make any assumptions).
6184 enum PromotedType {
6185 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
6186 };
6187 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
6188 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
6189 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6190 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6191 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6192 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
6193 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
6194 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
6195 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
6196 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
6197 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
6198 };
6199
6200 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6201 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6202 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6203
6204 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006205 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006206
6207 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6208 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006209 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6210 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006211 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6212 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6213
6214 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6215 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6216 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6217
6218 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6219 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6220 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6221 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6222 }
6223
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006224 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6225 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006226 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
6227 bool HasVolatile) {
6228 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6229 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6230 S.Context.IntTy
6231 };
6232
6233 // Non-volatile version.
6234 if (NumArgs == 1)
6235 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6236 else
6237 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6238
6239 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6240 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6241 if (HasVolatile) {
6242 ParamTypes[0] =
6243 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6244 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6245 if (NumArgs == 1)
6246 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6247 else
6248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6249 }
6250 }
6251
6252public:
6253 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6254 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6255 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006256 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006257 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006258 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6259 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6260 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006261 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6262 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006263 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6264 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6265 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006266 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006267 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006268 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
6269 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006270 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006271 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6272 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006273 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006274 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
6275 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006276 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6277 }
6278
6279 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6280 //
6281 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6282 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6283 // functions of the form
6284 //
6285 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6286 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6287 //
6288 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6289 //
6290 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6291 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6292 // candidate operator functions of the form
6293 //
6294 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6295 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6296 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006297 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6298 return;
6299
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006300 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6301 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6302 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006303 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006304 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
6305 }
6306 }
6307
6308 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6309 //
6310 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6311 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6312 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6313 //
6314 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6315 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6316 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6317 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6318 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6319 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6320 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6321 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6322 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6323 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006324 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006325 continue;
6326
6327 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
6328 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6329 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
6330 }
6331 }
6332
6333 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6334 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6335 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6336 //
6337 // T& operator*(T*);
6338 //
6339 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006340 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006341 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006342 // T& operator*(T*);
6343 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6344 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6345 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6346 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6347 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6348 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6349 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006350 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6351 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006352
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006353 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6354 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6355 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006356
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006357 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6358 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6359 }
6360 }
6361
6362 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6363 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6364 // operator functions of the form
6365 //
6366 // T operator+(T);
6367 // T operator-(T);
6368 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006369 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6370 return;
6371
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006372 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6373 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006374 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006375 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6376 }
6377
6378 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6379 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6380 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6381 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6382 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6383 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6384 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6385 }
6386 }
6387
6388 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6389 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6390 // the form
6391 //
6392 // T* operator+(T*);
6393 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6394 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6395 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6396 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6397 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6398 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6399 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6400 }
6401 }
6402
6403 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6404 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6405 // operator functions of the form
6406 //
6407 // T operator~(T);
6408 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006409 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6410 return;
6411
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006412 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6413 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006414 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006415 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6416 }
6417
6418 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6419 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6420 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6421 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6422 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6423 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6424 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6425 }
6426 }
6427
6428 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6429 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6430 // functions of the form
6431 //
6432 // bool operator==(T,T);
6433 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6434 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6435 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6436 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6437
6438 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6439 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6440 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6441 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6442 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6443 ++MemPtr) {
6444 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6445 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6446 continue;
6447
6448 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6449 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6450 CandidateSet);
6451 }
6452 }
6453 }
6454
6455 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6456 //
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006457 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6458 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006459 //
6460 // bool operator<(T, T);
6461 // bool operator>(T, T);
6462 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6463 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6464 // bool operator==(T, T);
6465 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006466 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6467 // C++ [over.built]p1:
6468 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
6469 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
6470 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
6471 // functions.
6472 //
6473 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
6474 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
6475 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
6476 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
6477 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
6478 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6479 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6480 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6481 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6482
6483 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6484 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6485 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6486 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6487 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6488 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6489 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6490 continue;
6491
6492 QualType FirstParamType =
6493 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6494 QualType SecondParamType =
6495 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6496
6497 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6498 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6499 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6500 continue;
6501
6502 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6503 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6504 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6505 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6506 }
6507 }
6508 }
6509
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006510 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6511 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6512
6513 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6514 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6515 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6516 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6517 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6518 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6519 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6520 continue;
6521
6522 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6523 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6524 CandidateSet);
6525 }
6526 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6527 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6528 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6529 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6530 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6531
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006532 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6533 // candidate exists.
6534 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6535 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6536 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006537 continue;
6538
6539 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006540 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6541 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006542 }
Douglas Gregor80af3132011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006543
6544 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6545 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6546 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6547 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6548 NullPtrTy))) {
6549 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6550 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6551 CandidateSet);
6552 }
6553 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006554 }
6555 }
6556
6557 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6558 //
6559 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6560 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6561 //
6562 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6563 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6564 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6565 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6566 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6567 //
6568 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6569 //
6570 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6571 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6572 //
6573 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6574 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6575 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6576 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6577
6578 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6579 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6580 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6581 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6582 };
6583 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6584 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6585 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6586 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006587 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6588 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6589 continue;
6590
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006591 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6592 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6593 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6594 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6595 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6596 CandidateSet);
6597 }
6598 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6599 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6600 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6601 continue;
6602
6603 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6604 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6605 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6606 }
6607 }
6608 }
6609 }
6610
6611 // C++ [over.built]p12:
6612 //
6613 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
6614 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6615 //
6616 // LR operator*(L, R);
6617 // LR operator/(L, R);
6618 // LR operator+(L, R);
6619 // LR operator-(L, R);
6620 // bool operator<(L, R);
6621 // bool operator>(L, R);
6622 // bool operator<=(L, R);
6623 // bool operator>=(L, R);
6624 // bool operator==(L, R);
6625 // bool operator!=(L, R);
6626 //
6627 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6628 // between types L and R.
6629 //
6630 // C++ [over.built]p24:
6631 //
6632 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
6633 // candidate operator functions of the form
6634 //
6635 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
6636 //
6637 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6638 // between types L and R.
6639 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
6640 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006641 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6642 return;
6643
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006644 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6645 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
6646 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6647 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006648 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6649 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006650 QualType Result =
6651 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006652 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006653 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6654 }
6655 }
6656
6657 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
6658 // conditional operator for vector types.
6659 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6660 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6661 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6662 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6663 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6664 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6665 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6666 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6667 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
6668 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
6669 if (!isComparison) {
6670 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
6671 Result = *Vec1;
6672 else
6673 Result = *Vec2;
6674 }
6675
6676 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6677 }
6678 }
6679 }
6680
6681 // C++ [over.built]p17:
6682 //
6683 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
6684 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6685 //
6686 // LR operator%(L, R);
6687 // LR operator&(L, R);
6688 // LR operator^(L, R);
6689 // LR operator|(L, R);
6690 // L operator<<(L, R);
6691 // L operator>>(L, R);
6692 //
6693 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6694 // between types L and R.
6695 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006696 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6697 return;
6698
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006699 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6700 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
6701 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6702 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006703 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6704 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006705 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
6706 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006707 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006708 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6709 }
6710 }
6711 }
6712
6713 // C++ [over.built]p20:
6714 //
6715 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
6716 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
6717 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6718 //
6719 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
6720 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6721 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6722 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6723
6724 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6725 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6726 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6727 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6728 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6729 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6730 continue;
6731
6732 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
6733 CandidateSet);
6734 }
6735
6736 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6737 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6738 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6739 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6740 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6741 continue;
6742
6743 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
6744 CandidateSet);
6745 }
6746 }
6747 }
6748
6749 // C++ [over.built]p19:
6750 //
6751 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
6752 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
6753 // of the form
6754 //
6755 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
6756 //
6757 // C++ [over.built]p21:
6758 //
6759 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6760 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
6761 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6762 //
6763 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6764 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6765 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
6766 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6767 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6768
6769 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6770 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6771 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6772 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6773 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
6774 if (isEqualOp)
6775 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006776 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
6777 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006778
6779 // non-volatile version
6780 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6781 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6782 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6783 };
6784 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6785 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
6786
6787 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6788 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6789 // volatile version
6790 ParamTypes[0] =
6791 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
6792 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6793 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6794 }
6795 }
6796
6797 if (isEqualOp) {
6798 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6799 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6800 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6801 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6802 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
6803 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6804 continue;
6805
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006806 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6807 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6808 *Ptr,
6809 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006810
6811 // non-volatile version
6812 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6813 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
6814
6815 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6816 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6817 // volatile version
6818 ParamTypes[0] =
6819 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006820 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6821 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006822 }
6823 }
6824 }
6825 }
6826
6827 // C++ [over.built]p18:
6828 //
6829 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
6830 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
6831 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
6832 // the form
6833 //
6834 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
6835 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
6836 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
6837 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
6838 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
6839 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006840 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6841 return;
6842
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006843 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
6844 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6845 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
6846 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006847 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006848
6849 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6850 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006851 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006852 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6853 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6854
6855 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6856 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6857 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006858 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006859 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006860 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6861 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006862 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6863 }
6864 }
6865 }
6866
6867 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
6868 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6869 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6870 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6871 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6872 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6873 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6874 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6875 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6876 QualType ParamTypes[2];
6877 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
6878 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6879 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
6880 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6881 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6882
6883 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6884 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6885 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
6886 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006887 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6888 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006889 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6890 }
6891 }
6892 }
6893 }
6894
6895 // C++ [over.built]p22:
6896 //
6897 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
6898 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
6899 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6900 //
6901 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
6902 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
6903 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
6904 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
6905 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
6906 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
6907 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006908 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6909 return;
6910
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006911 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
6912 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6913 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
6914 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006915 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006916
6917 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6918 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006919 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006920 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6921 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6922 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006923 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006924 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
6925 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6926 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6927 CandidateSet);
6928 }
6929 }
6930 }
6931 }
6932
6933 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
6934 //
6935 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
6936 //
6937 // bool operator!(bool);
6938 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
6939 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
6940 void addExclaimOverload() {
6941 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
6942 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
6943 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6944 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
6945 }
6946 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
6947 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
6948 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6949 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6950 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
6951 }
6952
6953 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6954 //
6955 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
6956 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6957 //
6958 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6959 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
6960 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6961 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
6962 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
6963 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
6964 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6965 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6966 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6967 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6968 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
6969 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006970 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6971 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006972
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006973 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6974
6975 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
6976 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6977 }
6978
6979 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6980 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6981 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6982 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6983 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
6984 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006985 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6986 continue;
6987
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006988 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6989
6990 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
6991 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6992 }
6993 }
6994
6995 // C++ [over.built]p11:
6996 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
6997 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
6998 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
6999 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7000 //
7001 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7002 //
7003 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7004 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7005 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7006 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7007 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7008 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7009 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7010 QualType C1;
7011 QualifierCollector Q1;
7012 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7013 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7014 continue;
7015 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7016 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7017 // volatile/restrict type.
7018 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7019 continue;
7020 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7021 continue;
7022 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7023 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7024 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7025 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7026 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7027 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7028 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7029 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7030 break;
7031 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7032 // build CV12 T&
7033 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7034 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7035 T.isVolatileQualified())
7036 continue;
7037 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7038 T.isRestrictQualified())
7039 continue;
7040 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7041 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7042 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7043 }
7044 }
7045 }
7046
7047 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7048 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7049 // therefore added as binary.
7050 //
7051 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7052 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7053 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7054 //
7055 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7056 //
7057 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7058 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7059 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7060
7061 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7062 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7063 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7064 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7065 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7066 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7067 continue;
7068
7069 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7070 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7071 }
7072
7073 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7074 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7075 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7076 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7077 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7078 continue;
7079
7080 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7081 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7082 }
7083
7084 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
7085 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7086 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7087 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7088 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7089 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7090 continue;
7091
7092 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7093 continue;
7094
7095 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7096 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7097 }
7098 }
7099 }
7100 }
7101};
7102
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007103} // end anonymous namespace
7104
7105/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7106/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7107/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7108/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7109/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7110void
7111Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7112 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7113 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7114 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007115 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7116 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007117 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7118 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007119 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7120 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007121 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7122 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007123
7124 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7125 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007126 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007127 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7128 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7129 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7130 OpLoc,
7131 true,
7132 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7133 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7134 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7135 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007136 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7137 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7138 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7139 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7140 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007141 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007142
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007143 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7144 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor877d4eb2011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007145 //
7146 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7147 // 'bool' overloads.
7148 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7149 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007150 return;
7151
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007152 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7153 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7154 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007155 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007156 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7157
7158 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007159 switch (Op) {
7160 case OO_None:
7161 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007162 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007163
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007164 case OO_New:
7165 case OO_Delete:
7166 case OO_Array_New:
7167 case OO_Array_Delete:
7168 case OO_Call:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007169 llvm_unreachable(
7170 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007171
7172 case OO_Comma:
7173 case OO_Arrow:
7174 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7175 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7176 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007177 break;
7178
7179 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007180 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007181 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007182 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007183
7184 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007185 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007186 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007187 } else {
7188 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7189 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7190 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007191 break;
7192
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007193 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007194 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007195 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7196 else
7197 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7198 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007199
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007200 case OO_Slash:
7201 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007202 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007203
7204 case OO_PlusPlus:
7205 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007206 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7207 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007208 break;
7209
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007210 case OO_EqualEqual:
7211 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007212 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007213 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007214
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007215 case OO_Less:
7216 case OO_Greater:
7217 case OO_LessEqual:
7218 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007219 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007220 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7221 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007222
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007223 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007224 case OO_Caret:
7225 case OO_Pipe:
7226 case OO_LessLess:
7227 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007228 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007229 break;
7230
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007231 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7232 if (NumArgs == 1)
7233 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7234 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7235 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7236 break;
7237
7238 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7239 break;
7240
7241 case OO_Tilde:
7242 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7243 break;
7244
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007245 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007246 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007247 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007248
7249 case OO_PlusEqual:
7250 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007251 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007252 // Fall through.
7253
7254 case OO_StarEqual:
7255 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007256 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007257 break;
7258
7259 case OO_PercentEqual:
7260 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7261 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7262 case OO_AmpEqual:
7263 case OO_CaretEqual:
7264 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007265 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007266 break;
7267
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007268 case OO_Exclaim:
7269 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007270 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007271
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007272 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007273 case OO_PipePipe:
7274 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007275 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007276
7277 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007278 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007279 break;
7280
7281 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007282 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007283 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007284
7285 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007286 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007287 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7288 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007289 }
7290}
7291
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007292/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7293/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7294///
7295/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7296/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7297/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7298/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007299void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007300Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007301 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007302 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007303 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007304 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007305 bool PartialOverloading,
7306 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007307 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007308
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007309 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7310 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7311 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7312 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7313 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7314 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7315
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007316 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00007317 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
7318 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007319
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007320 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007321 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7322 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7323 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007324 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007325 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007326 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007327 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007328 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007329
7330 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7331 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007332 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007333 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007334 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007335 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007336 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007337
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007338 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007339 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007340 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007341 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007342 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00007343 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007344 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007345}
7346
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007347/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7348/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007349bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007350isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007351 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7352 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007353 SourceLocation Loc,
7354 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007355 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7356 // functions.
7357 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7358 return Cand1.Viable;
7359 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7360 return false;
7361
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007362 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7363 //
7364 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7365 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7366 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7367 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7368 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7369 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7370 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007371
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007372 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007373 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7374 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007375 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007376 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7377 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007378 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007379 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007380 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7381 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007382 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7383 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7384 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7385 HasBetterConversion = true;
7386 break;
7387
7388 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7389 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7390 return false;
7391
7392 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7393 // Do nothing.
7394 break;
7395 }
7396 }
7397
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007398 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007399 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007400 if (HasBetterConversion)
7401 return true;
7402
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007403 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007404 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007405 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007406 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7407 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007408
7409 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7410 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7411 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007412 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007413 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007414 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007415 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007416 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7417 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7418 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007419 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007420 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007421 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007422 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007423 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007424
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007425 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7426 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7427 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7428 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7429 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7430 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007431 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007432 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007433 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007434 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7435 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007436 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7437 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7438 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7439 return true;
7440
7441 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7442 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7443 return false;
7444
7445 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7446 // Do nothing
7447 break;
7448 }
7449 }
7450
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007451 return false;
7452}
7453
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007454/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007455/// within an overload candidate set.
7456///
7457/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
7458///
7459/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
7460/// which overload resolution occurs.
7461///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007462/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007463/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
7464///
7465/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007466OverloadingResult
7467OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007468 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007469 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007470 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007471 Best = end();
7472 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7473 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007474 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007475 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007476 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007477 }
7478
7479 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007480 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007481 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7482
7483 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7484 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007485 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007486 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007487 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007488 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007489 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007490 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007491 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007492 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007493 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007494
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007495 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007496 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007497 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7498 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007499 return OR_Deleted;
7500
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007501 return OR_Success;
7502}
7503
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007504namespace {
7505
7506enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7507 oc_function,
7508 oc_method,
7509 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007510 oc_function_template,
7511 oc_method_template,
7512 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007513 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7514 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007515 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007516 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007517 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007518 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007519};
7520
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007521OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7522 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7523 std::string &Description) {
7524 bool isTemplate = false;
7525
7526 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7527 isTemplate = true;
7528 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7529 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7530 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007531
7532 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007533 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007534 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007535
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007536 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7537 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7538
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007539 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7540 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7541
7542 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7543 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7544
7545 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7546 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7547 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007548 }
7549
7550 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7551 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7552 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007553 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007554 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007555
Alexis Hunt119c10e2011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007556 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7557 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7558
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00007559 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007560 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007561 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7562 }
7563
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007564 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007565}
7566
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007567void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
7568 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
7569 if (!Ctor) return;
7570
7571 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
7572 if (!Ctor) return;
7573
7574 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
7575}
7576
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007577} // end anonymous namespace
7578
7579// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007580void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007581 std::string FnDesc;
7582 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007583 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7584 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
7585 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
7586 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007587 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007588}
7589
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007590//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
7591// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007592void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007593 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7594
7595 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
7596 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
7597
7598 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7599 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7600 I != IEnd; ++I) {
7601 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
7602 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007603 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007604 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
7605 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007606 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007607 }
7608 }
7609}
7610
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007611/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
7612/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
7613/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007614void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
7615 Sema &S,
7616 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7617 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
7618 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
7619 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007620 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007621 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7622 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007623 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007624}
7625
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007626namespace {
7627
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007628void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
7629 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
7630 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007631 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
7632 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7633
7634 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
7635 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
7636 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007637 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007638 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007639 if (I == 0)
7640 isObjectArgument = true;
7641 else
7642 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007643 }
7644
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007645 std::string FnDesc;
7646 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
7647
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007648 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
7649 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
7650 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007651
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007652 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007653 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007654 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
7655 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
7656 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007657 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007658
7659 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
7660 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7661 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7662 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007663 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00007664 return;
7665 }
7666
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007667 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
7668 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007669 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
7670 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
7671 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7672 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
7673 else {
7674 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
7675 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7676 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7677 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
7678 }
7679
7680 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
7681 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
7682 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
7683 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
7684 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7685 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
7686 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7687
7688 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7689 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7690
7691 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
7692 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
7693 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7694 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7695 << FromTy
7696 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
7697 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007698 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007699 return;
7700 }
7701
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007702 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscff00d92011-06-24 00:08:59 +00007703 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007704 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7705 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7706 << FromTy
7707 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
7708 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7709 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7710 return;
7711 }
7712
Douglas Gregoraec25842011-04-26 23:16:46 +00007713 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
7714 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
7715 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7716 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7717 << FromTy
7718 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
7719 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7720 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7721 return;
7722 }
7723
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007724 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
7725 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
7726
7727 if (isObjectArgument) {
7728 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
7729 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7730 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7731 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
7732 } else {
7733 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
7734 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7735 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7736 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
7737 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007738 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007739 return;
7740 }
7741
Sebastian Redla72462c2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00007742 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
7743 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
7744 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
7745 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
7746 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7747 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7748 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7749 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7750 return;
7751 }
7752
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007753 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
7754 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
7755 // the failure.
7756 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
7757 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7758 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7759 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
7760 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
7761 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7762 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7763 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007764 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00007765 return;
7766 }
7767
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007768 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007769 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007770 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7771 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7772 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7773 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7774 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7775 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007776 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007777 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007778 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007779 }
7780 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
7781 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
7782 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
7783 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7784 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7785 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7786 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7787 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7788 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007789 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
7790 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
7791 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
7792 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
7793 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7794 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
7795 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
7796 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007797
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007798 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007799 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007800 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007801 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7802 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00007803 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007804 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007805 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007806 return;
7807 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007808
Fariborz Jahaniana644f9c2011-07-20 17:14:09 +00007809 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
7810 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
7811 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7812 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7813 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7814 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
7815 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7816 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7817 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7818 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7819 return;
7820 }
7821 }
7822
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007823 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
7824 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
7825 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007826 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007827 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
7828 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
7829
7830 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer490afa62012-01-14 21:05:10 +00007831 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
7832 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007833 FDiag << *HI;
7834 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
7835
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007836 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007837}
7838
7839void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7840 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
7841 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
7842
7843 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7844 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7845
7846 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007847
Douglas Gregor1d33f8d2011-05-05 00:13:13 +00007848 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
7849 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
7850 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
7851 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
7852 // Just don't report anything.
7853 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
7854 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
7855 return;
7856
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007857 // at least / at most / exactly
7858 unsigned mode, modeCount;
7859 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007860 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
7861 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7862 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007863 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00007864 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007865 mode = 0; // "at least"
7866 else
7867 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7868 modeCount = MinParams;
7869 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007870 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
7871 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7872 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007873 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
7874 mode = 1; // "at most"
7875 else
7876 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7877 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
7878 }
7879
7880 std::string Description;
7881 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
7882
7883 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007884 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007885 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007886 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007887}
7888
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007889/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
7890void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7891 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7892 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
7893
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007894 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007895 NamedDecl *ParamD;
7896 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
7897 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
7898 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007899 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
7900 case Sema::TDK_Success:
7901 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
7902
7903 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007904 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
7905 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
7906 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007907 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007908 return;
7909 }
7910
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007911 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
7912 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
7913 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
7914
7915 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
7916
7917 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
7918 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007919 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007920 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007921 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007922 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
7923
7924 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
7925 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
7926 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
7927 // done on dependent types).
7928 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
7929
7930 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
7931 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007932 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007933 return;
7934 }
7935
7936 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007937 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007938 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007939 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007940 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007941 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007942 which = 1;
7943 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007944 which = 2;
7945 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007946
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007947 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007948 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007949 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
7950 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007951 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007952 return;
7953 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007954
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007955 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007956 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007957 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007958 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007959 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
7960 << ParamD->getDeclName();
7961 else {
7962 int index = 0;
7963 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
7964 index = TTP->getIndex();
7965 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
7966 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
7967 index = NTTP->getIndex();
7968 else
7969 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007970 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007971 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
7972 << (index + 1);
7973 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007974 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007975 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007976
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007977 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7978 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7979 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
7980 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007981
7982 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7983 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007984 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007985 return;
7986
7987 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
7988 std::string ArgString;
7989 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
7990 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
7991 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7992 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
7993 *Args);
7994 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
7995 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007996 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007997 return;
7998 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007999
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008000 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8001 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008002 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008003 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8004 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008005 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008006 return;
8007 }
8008}
8009
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008010/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8011void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8012 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8013 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8014
8015 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8016 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8017
8018 std::string FnDesc;
8019 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8020
8021 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8022 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8023}
8024
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008025/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8026/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8027///
8028/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8029/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8030/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8031/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8032/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8033/// overload.
8034///
8035/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8036/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8037/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008038void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8039 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008040 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8041
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008042 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisab72b672011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008043 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8044 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008045 std::string FnDesc;
8046 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008047
8048 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008049 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008050 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008051 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008052 }
8053
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008054 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8055 if (Cand->Viable) {
8056 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8057 return;
8058 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008059
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008060 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8061 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8062 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8063 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008064
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008065 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008066 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
8067
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008068 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8069 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008070 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008071 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008072
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008073 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8074 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008075 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008076 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8077 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008078
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008079 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8080 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8081 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8082 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008083 }
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008084
8085 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8086 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008087 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008088}
8089
8090void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8091 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8092 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8093 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8094 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8095 bool isLValueReference = false;
8096 bool isRValueReference = false;
8097 bool isPointer = false;
8098 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8099 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8100 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8101 isLValueReference = true;
8102 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8103 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8104 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8105 isRValueReference = true;
8106 }
8107 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8108 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8109 isPointer = true;
8110 }
8111 // Desugar down to a function type.
8112 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8113 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8114 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8115 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8116 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8117
8118 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8119 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008120 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008121}
8122
8123void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
8124 const char *Opc,
8125 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8126 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008127 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008128 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8129 TypeStr += Opc;
8130 TypeStr += "(";
8131 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008132 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008133 TypeStr += ")";
8134 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8135 } else {
8136 TypeStr += ", ";
8137 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8138 TypeStr += ")";
8139 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8140 }
8141}
8142
8143void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8144 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008145 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008146 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8147 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008148 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8149 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8150
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008151 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008152 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008153 }
8154}
8155
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008156SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8157 if (Cand->Function)
8158 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008159 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008160 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8161 return SourceLocation();
8162}
8163
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008164static unsigned
8165RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth73fddfe2011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008166 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008167 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008168 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008169
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008170 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8171 return 1;
8172
8173 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8174 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8175 return 2;
8176
8177 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8178 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8179 return 3;
8180
8181 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8182 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8183 return 4;
8184
8185 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8186 return 5;
8187
8188 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8189 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8190 return 6;
8191 }
Benjamin Kramer8a8051f2011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008192 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008193}
8194
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008195struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8196 Sema &S;
8197 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008198
8199 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8200 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008201 // Fast-path this check.
8202 if (L == R) return false;
8203
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008204 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008205 if (L->Viable) {
8206 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8207
8208 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8209 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8210 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008211 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8212 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008213 } else if (R->Viable)
8214 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008215
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008216 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008217
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008218 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8219 if (!L->Viable) {
8220 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8221 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8222 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8223 return false;
8224 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8225 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8226 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008227
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008228 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8229 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8230 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8231 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8232 return true;
8233
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008234 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8235 // comes first.
8236 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8237 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8238 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8239 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008240 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008241 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8242 return true;
8243 else
8244 return false;
Anna Zaks9ccf84e2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008245 }
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008246
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008247 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8248 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008249 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008250
8251 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008252 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008253 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008254 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8255 L->Conversions[I],
8256 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008257 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8258 leftBetter++;
8259 break;
8260
8261 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8262 leftBetter--;
8263 break;
8264
8265 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8266 break;
8267 }
8268 }
8269 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8270 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8271
8272 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8273 return false;
8274
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008275 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8276 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8277 return true;
8278
8279 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8280 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedman1e7a0c62011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008281 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedmane2c600c2011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008282 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8283 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrain45e93702011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008284
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008285 // TODO: others?
8286 }
8287
8288 // Sort everything else by location.
8289 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8290 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8291
8292 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8293 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8294 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8295
8296 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008297 }
8298};
8299
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008300/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008301/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008302void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8303 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8304 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8305
8306 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8307 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8308
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008309 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8310 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008311 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8312 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008313
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008314 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008315 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramerb0095172012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008316 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008317 while (true) {
8318 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8319 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008320 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008321 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008322 break;
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008323 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008324 }
8325
8326 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8327 return;
8328
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008329 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8330 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8331
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008332 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008333 // operation somehow.
8334 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008335
8336 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8337 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8338
8339 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8340 QualType ConvType
8341 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8342 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8343 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8344 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8345 ArgIdx--;
8346 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8347 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8348 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8349 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8350 ArgIdx--;
8351 } else {
8352 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8353 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8354 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8355 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008356 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8357 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008358 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008359 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8360 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8361 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008362 return;
8363 }
8364
8365 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8366 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8367 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008368 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008369 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008370 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008371 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008372 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8373 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
8374 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008375 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8376 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaks1b068122011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008377 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksdf92ddf2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008378 }
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008379 else
8380 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8381 }
8382}
8383
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008384} // end anonymous namespace
8385
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008386/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8387/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008388/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008389void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8390 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
8391 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8392 const char *Opc,
8393 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008394 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8395 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008396 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008397 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8398 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008399 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008400 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008401 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008402 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008403 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8404 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8405 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8406 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008407 }
8408 }
8409
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008410 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008411 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008412
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008413 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008414
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008415 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008416 const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads =
8417 S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008418 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008419 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8420 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008421
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008422 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8423 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8424 // candidate list.
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00008425 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008426 break;
8427 }
8428 ++CandsShown;
8429
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008430 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008431 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008432 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008433 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008434 else {
8435 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8436 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008437 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8438 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8439 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8440 //
8441 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8442 // different ambiguities, though.
8443 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008444 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008445 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8446 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008447
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008448 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008449 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008450 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008451 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008452
8453 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008454 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008455}
8456
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008457// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8458// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8459// R (A) --> R(A)
8460// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8461// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8462// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8463QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8464 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8465 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8466 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8467 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8468 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8469 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8470 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008471 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008472 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8473 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8474 Ret =
8475 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8476 return Ret;
8477}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008478
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008479// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8480// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8481class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8482{
8483 Sema& S;
8484 Expr* SourceExpr;
8485 const QualType& TargetType;
8486 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8487
8488 bool Complain;
8489 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8490 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008491
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008492 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8493 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008494
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008495 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8496 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8497 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008498 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008499
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008500public:
8501 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
8502 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
8503 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
8504 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
8505 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
8506 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
8507 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
8508 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
8509 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
8510 {
8511 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
8512
8513 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
8514 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8515 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008516 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008517 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00008518
8519 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8520 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8521 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
8522 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
8523 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
8524 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
8525
8526 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
8527 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
8528 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
8529 return;
8530 }
8531 }
8532
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008533 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
8534 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008535 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008536 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008537 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008538
8539 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
8540 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008541
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008542 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
8543 // C++ [over.over]p4:
8544 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
8545 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
8546 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
8547 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
8548 else
8549 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
8550 }
8551 }
8552 }
8553
8554private:
8555 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
8556 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
8557 }
8558
8559 // [ToType] [Return]
8560
8561 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8562 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8563 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
8564 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
8565 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
8566 }
8567
8568 // return true if any matching specializations were found
8569 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
8570 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
8571 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
8572 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
8573 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
8574 // static when converting to member pointer.
8575 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8576 return false;
8577 }
8578 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8579 return false;
8580
8581 // C++ [over.over]p2:
8582 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
8583 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
8584 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
8585 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
8586 // overloaded functions considered.
8587 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
8588 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
8589 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
8590 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
8591 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
8592 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
8593 Info)) {
8594 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8595 (void)Result;
8596 return false;
8597 }
8598
8599 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
8600 // This function template specicalization works.
8601 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
8602 assert(TargetFunctionType
8603 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
8604 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
8605 return true;
8606 }
8607
8608 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
8609 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008610 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008611 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
8612 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008613 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8614 return false;
8615 }
8616 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8617 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008618
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00008619 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Peter Collingbourne7277fe82011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008620 if (S.getLangOptions().CUDA)
8621 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
8622 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
8623 return false;
8624
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00008625 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008626 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
8627 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth53e61b02011-06-18 01:19:03 +00008628 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
8629 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008630 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
8631 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008632 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008633 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00008634 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008635 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008636
8637 return false;
8638 }
8639
8640 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
8641 bool Ret = false;
8642
8643 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
8644 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
8645 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8646 return false;
8647
8648 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8649 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8650 I != E; ++I) {
8651 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
8652 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
8653
8654 // C++ [over.over]p3:
8655 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
8656 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
8657 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
8658 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
8659 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
8660 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8661 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
8662 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
8663 Ret = true;
8664 }
8665 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
8666 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
8667 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
8668 Ret = true;
8669 }
8670 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
8671 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008672 }
8673
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008674 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008675 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
8676 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
8677 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
8678 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
8679 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
8680
8681 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
8682 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
8683 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
8684 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008685
8686 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
8687 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
8688 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008689
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008690 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008691 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
8692 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
8693 S.PDiag(),
8694 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8695 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
8696 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8697 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008698 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008699
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008700 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
8701 // Make it the first and only element
8702 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
8703 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
8704 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008705 }
8706 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008707
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008708 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
8709 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
8710 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
8711 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
8712 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
8713 ++I;
8714 else {
8715 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
8716 Matches.set_size(N);
8717 }
8718 }
8719 }
8720
8721public:
8722 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
8723 assert(Matches.empty());
8724 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
8725 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
8726 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008727 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008728 }
8729
8730 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8731 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
8732 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
8733 }
8734
8735 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8736 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
8737 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
8738 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
8739 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
8740 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8741 }
8742
8743 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
8744 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
8745 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
8746 }
8747
8748 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
8749 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
8750 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8751 << OvlExpr->getName()
8752 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieucaff2472011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008753 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008754 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008755
8756 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
8757
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008758 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
8759
8760 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
8761 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8762 return Matches[0].second;
8763 }
8764
8765 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
8766 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8767 return &Matches[0].first;
8768 }
8769};
8770
8771/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
8772/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
8773/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
8774/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
8775///
8776/// @code
8777/// int f(double);
8778/// int f(int);
8779///
8780/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
8781/// @endcode
8782///
8783/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
8784/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
8785/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
8786FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008787Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
8788 QualType TargetType,
8789 bool Complain,
8790 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
8791 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008792 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008793
8794 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
8795 Complain);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008796 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
8797 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008798 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008799 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8800 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
8801 else
8802 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
8803 }
8804 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
8805 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
8806 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
8807 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
8808 assert(Fn);
8809 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
8810 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00008811 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008812 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00008813 }
Abramo Bagnara5001caa2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00008814
8815 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
8816 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008817 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008818}
8819
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008820/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008821/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
8822///
8823/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
8824/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008825/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008826/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008827FunctionDecl *
8828Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
8829 bool Complain,
8830 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008831 // C++ [over.over]p1:
8832 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
8833 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008834 // C++ [over.over]p1:
8835 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
8836 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008837
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008838 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008839 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008840 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008841
8842 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008843 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008844
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008845 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
8846 // whose type matches exactly.
8847 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008848 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
8849 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008850 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
8851 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008852 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
8853 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
8854 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008855 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00008856 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8857 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008858
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008859 // C++ [over.over]p2:
8860 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
8861 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
8862 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
8863 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
8864 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008865 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008866 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008867 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
8868 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8869 Specialization, Info)) {
8870 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8871 (void)Result;
8872 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008873 }
8874
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008875 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
8876
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008877 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008878 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008879 if (Complain) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008880 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8881 << ovl->getName();
8882 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008883 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008884 return 0;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008885 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008886
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008887 Matched = Specialization;
8888 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008889 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008890
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008891 return Matched;
8892}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008893
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008894
8895
8896
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008897// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
8898// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
8899//
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008900// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008901//
8902// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
8903// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
8904// returns true if 'complain' is set.
8905bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8906 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
8907 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008908 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008909 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008910 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008911
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008912 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008913
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008914 DeclAccessPair found;
8915 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
8916 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8917 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008918 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
8919 SrcExpr = ExprError();
8920 return true;
8921 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008922
8923 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
8924 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
8925 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
8926 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
8927 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
8928 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
8929 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008930 if (!complain) return false;
8931
8932 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
8933 diag::err_bound_member_function)
8934 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
8935
8936 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
8937 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
8938 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
8939 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
8940 // the static candidates were rejected.
8941 SrcExpr = ExprError();
8942 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008943 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00008944
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008945 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
8946 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008947 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008948
8949 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008950 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008951 SingleFunctionExpression =
8952 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008953 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
8954 SrcExpr = ExprError();
8955 return true;
8956 }
8957 }
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008958 }
8959
8960 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
8961 if (complain) {
8962 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
8963 << ovl.Expression->getName()
8964 << DestTypeForComplaining
8965 << OpRangeForComplaining
8966 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008967 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
8968
8969 SrcExpr = ExprError();
8970 return true;
8971 }
8972
8973 return false;
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008974 }
8975
John McCall50a2c2c2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00008976 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
8977 return true;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008978}
8979
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008980/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
8981static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008982 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008983 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008984 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8985 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008986 bool PartialOverloading,
8987 bool KnownValid) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008988 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008989 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
8990 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
8991
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008992 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008993 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
8994 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
8995 return;
8996 }
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008997 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00008998 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008999 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009000 }
9001
9002 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9003 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009004 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
9005 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009006 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009007 return;
9008 }
9009
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009010 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009011}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009012
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009013/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9014/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009015void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009016 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9017 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9018 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009019
9020#ifndef NDEBUG
9021 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9022 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009023 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009024 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9025 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9026 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9027 //
9028 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9029 //
9030 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009031 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009032 //
9033 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9034 // template
9035 //
9036 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009037
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009038 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9039 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9040 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9041 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9042 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9043 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9044 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009045 }
9046 }
9047#endif
9048
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009049 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9050 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009051 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009052 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9053 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9054 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9055 }
9056
9057 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9058 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009059 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009060 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009061 PartialOverloading, /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009062
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009063 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009064 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
9065 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009066 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009067 CandidateSet,
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009068 PartialOverloading,
9069 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009070}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009071
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009072/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9073/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9074/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9075/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9076///
9077/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9078static bool
9079DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9080 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9081 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9082 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
9083 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9084 return false;
9085
9086 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
9087 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9088
9089 if (!R.empty()) {
9090 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9091
9092 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9093 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9094 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9095 R.clear();
9096 return false;
9097 }
9098
9099 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9100 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9101 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
9102 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009103 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009104
9105 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009106 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009107 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9108 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009109 R.clear();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009110 return false;
Richard Smith95ce4f62011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009111 }
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009112
9113 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9114 // declaring the function there instead.
9115 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9116 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
9117 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, NumArgs,
9118 AssociatedNamespaces,
9119 AssociatedClasses);
9120 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009121 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009122 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009123 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9124 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009125 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
9126 if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
9127 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
9128 }
Chandler Carruthd54186a2011-06-08 10:13:17 +00009129 } else {
9130 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
9131 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009132 }
9133
9134 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9135 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009136 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009137 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9138 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9139 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009140 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009141 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9142 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruthd50f1692011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009143 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009144 } else {
9145 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9146 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9147 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9148 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9149 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9150 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9151 }
9152
9153 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9154 return true;
9155 }
9156
9157 R.clear();
9158 }
9159
9160 return false;
9161}
9162
9163/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9164/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9165/// was defined.
9166///
9167/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9168static bool
9169DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9170 SourceLocation OpLoc,
9171 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
9172 DeclarationName OpName =
9173 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9174 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9175 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
9176 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args, NumArgs);
9177}
9178
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009179namespace {
9180// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9181// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9182// that accept the given number of arguments.
9183class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9184 public:
9185 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9186 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9187 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus;
9188 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9189 }
9190
9191 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9192 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9193 return candidate.isKeyword();
9194
9195 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9196 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9197 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9198 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9199 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9200 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9201 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9202 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9203 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9204 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9205 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9206 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9207 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9208 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9209 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9210 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9211 return true;
9212 }
9213 }
9214 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9215 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9216 return true;
9217 }
9218 return false;
9219 }
9220
9221 private:
9222 unsigned NumArgs;
9223 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9224};
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009225
9226// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9227class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9228 public:
9229 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9230 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9231 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9232 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9233 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9234 }
9235
9236 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9237 return false;
9238 }
9239};
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009240}
9241
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009242/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9243///
9244/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009245static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009246BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009247 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9248 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9249 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009250 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009251 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009252
9253 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009254 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009255 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009256
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009257 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009258 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009259 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9260 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9261 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9262 }
9263
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009264 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9265 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Kaelyn Uhrain8edb17d2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009266 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, NumArgs, ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009267 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9268 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9269 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9270 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009271 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
9272 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs) &&
9273 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009274 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Kaelyn Uhrain42830922011-08-05 00:09:52 +00009275 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs)))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009276 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009277
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009278 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9279
9280 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9281 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009282 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009283 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009284 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9285 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009286 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009287 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
9288 *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009289 else
9290 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9291
9292 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009293 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009294
9295 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009296 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009297 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009298 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009299 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009300}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009301
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009302/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00009303/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9304/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9305/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9306/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00009307/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009308/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009309ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009310Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009311 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9312 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009313 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009314 Expr *ExecConfig,
9315 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009316#ifndef NDEBUG
9317 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9318 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9319 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9320
9321 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9322 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9323 FunctionDecl *F;
9324 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9325 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9326 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009327 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009328
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009329 // We don't perform ADL in C.
9330 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00009331 } else
9332 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
9333 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009334#endif
9335
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009336 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
9337 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
9338 return ExprError();
9339
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009340 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009341
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009342 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9343 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
9344 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009345
9346 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009347 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9348 // out if it fails.
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009349 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009350 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9351 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009352 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009353 // classes.
Francois Pichetf707ae62011-11-11 00:12:11 +00009354 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetde232cb2011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009355 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Sebastian Redlb49c46c2011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009356 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
9357 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9358 RParenLoc);
9359 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
9360 return Owned(CE);
9361 }
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009362 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009363 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9364 AllowTypoCorrection);
Francois Pichetbcf64712011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009365 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009366
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009367 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9368
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009369 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009370 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009371 case OR_Success: {
9372 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009373 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009374 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009375 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009376 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00009377 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
9378 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009379 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009380
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009381 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9382 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9383 // have meant to call.
9384 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9385 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain9afaf792012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009386 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9387 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009388 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9389 return Recovery;
9390
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00009391 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009392 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009393 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009394 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009395 break;
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009396 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009397
9398 case OR_Ambiguous:
9399 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009400 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009401 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009402 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009403
9404 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009405 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009406 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9407 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9408 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009409 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009410 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009411 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3eaa22a2011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009412
9413 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9414 // the call in the AST.
9415 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
9416 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9417 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9418 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00009419 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009420 }
9421
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009422 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009423 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009424}
9425
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009426static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00009427 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
9428 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
9429}
9430
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009431/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9432/// operator.
9433///
9434/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
9435///
9436/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9437/// operator.
9438///
9439/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9440/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9441/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9442/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9443/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9444/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
9445///
9446/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009447ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009448Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
9449 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009450 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009451 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009452
9453 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9454 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
9455 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009456 // TODO: provide better source location info.
9457 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009458
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009459 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
9460 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009461
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009462 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
9463 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009464
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009465 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
9466 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
9467 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009468 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009469 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00009470 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
9471 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009472 NumArgs = 2;
9473 }
9474
9475 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009476 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009477 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009478 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009479 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009480 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009481 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009482
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009483 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009484 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00009485 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009486 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009487 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
9488 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009489 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009490 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009491 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009492 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009493 OpLoc));
9494 }
9495
9496 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009497 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009498
9499 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009500 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009501
9502 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9503 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9504
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009505 // Add candidates from ADL.
9506 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00009507 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009508 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9509 CandidateSet);
9510
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009511 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009512 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009513
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009514 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9515
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009516 // Perform overload resolution.
9517 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009518 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009519 case OR_Success: {
9520 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9521 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009522
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009523 if (FnDecl) {
9524 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9525 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009526
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009527 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
9528
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009529 // Convert the arguments.
9530 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009531 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009532
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009533 ExprResult InputRes =
9534 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9535 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9536 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009537 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009538 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009539 } else {
9540 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009541 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009542 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009543 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00009544 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009545 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009546 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00009547 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009548 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009549 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009550 }
9551
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009552 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9553
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009554 // Determine the result type.
9555 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9556 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9557 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009558
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009559 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009560 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9561 HadMultipleCandidates);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009562 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9563 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009564
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00009565 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009566 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009567 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009568 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009569
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009570 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00009571 FnDecl))
9572 return ExprError();
9573
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009574 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009575 } else {
9576 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9577 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9578 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009579 ExprResult InputRes =
9580 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9581 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9582 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
9583 return ExprError();
9584 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009585 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009586 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009587 }
9588
9589 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009590 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
9591 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
9592 // defined too late to be candidates.
9593 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, NumArgs))
9594 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
9595 return ExprError();
9596
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009597 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
9598 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
9599 break;
9600
9601 case OR_Ambiguous:
9602 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9603 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9604 << Input->getType()
9605 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009606 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009607 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9608 return ExprError();
9609
9610 case OR_Deleted:
9611 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9612 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9613 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9614 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9615 << Input->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009616 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
9617 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009618 return ExprError();
9619 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009620
9621 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
9622 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
9623 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009624 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009625}
9626
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009627/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9628/// operator.
9629///
9630/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
9631///
9632/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9633/// operator.
9634///
9635/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
9636/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9637/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9638/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9639/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9640/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
9641///
9642/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
9643/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009644ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009645Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009646 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009647 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009648 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009649 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009650 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009651
9652 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
9653 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9654 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9655
9656 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
9657 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009658 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009659 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009660 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009661 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009662 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009663 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009664 Context.DependentTy,
9665 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9666 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009667
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009668 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
9669 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009670 VK_LValue,
9671 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00009672 Context.DependentTy,
9673 Context.DependentTy,
9674 OpLoc));
9675 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009676
9677 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009678 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009679 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
9680 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009681 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009682 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
9683 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
9684 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009685 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009686 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009687 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009688 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009689 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009690 OpLoc));
9691 }
9692
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009693 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
9694 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9695 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009696
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00009697 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
9698 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
9699 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009700 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9701 return ExprError();
9702
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00009703 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
9704 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
9705 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
9706 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
9707 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
9708 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009709 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009710 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009711
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009712 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
9713 // create a built-in binary operator.
9714 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
9715 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9716
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009717 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009718 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009719
9720 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009721 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009722
9723 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9724 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9725
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009726 // Add candidates from ADL.
9727 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
9728 Args, 2,
9729 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9730 CandidateSet);
9731
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009732 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00009733 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009734
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009735 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9736
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009737 // Perform overload resolution.
9738 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009739 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00009740 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009741 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9742 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9743
9744 if (FnDecl) {
9745 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9746 // operator.
9747
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009748 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
9749
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009750 // Convert the arguments.
9751 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009752 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009753 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00009754
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009755 ExprResult Arg1 =
9756 PerformCopyInitialization(
9757 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9758 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9759 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009760 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009761 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009762
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009763 ExprResult Arg0 =
9764 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9765 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9766 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009767 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009768 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009769 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009770 } else {
9771 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009772 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
9773 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9774 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9775 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009776 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009777 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009778
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009779 ExprResult Arg1 =
9780 PerformCopyInitialization(
9781 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9782 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
9783 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00009784 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
9785 return ExprError();
9786 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
9787 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009788 }
9789
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009790 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9791
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009792 // Determine the result type.
9793 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9794 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9795 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009796
9797 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009798 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9799 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009800 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9801 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009802
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009803 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009804 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009805 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009806
9807 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009808 FnDecl))
9809 return ExprError();
9810
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009811 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009812 } else {
9813 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9814 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9815 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009816 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9817 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9818 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9819 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009820 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009821 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009822
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009823 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9824 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9825 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9826 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9827 return ExprError();
9828 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009829 break;
9830 }
9831 }
9832
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009833 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9834 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
9835 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
9836 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
9837 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009838 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009839 break;
9840
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009841 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
9842 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
9843 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009844 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009845 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009846 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00009847 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
9848 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009849 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009850 } else {
Richard Smith998a5912011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009851 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
9852 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
9853 // defined too late to be candidates.
9854 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, 2))
9855 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
9856 return ExprError();
9857
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009858 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
9859 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
9860 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00009861 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009862 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009863 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
9864 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009865 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9866 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009867 return move(Result);
9868 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009869
9870 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009871 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009872 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009873 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009874 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009875 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
9876 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009877 return ExprError();
9878
9879 case OR_Deleted:
9880 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9881 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9882 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009883 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009884 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman79b2d3a2011-08-26 19:46:22 +00009885 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9886 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009887 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009888 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009889
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00009890 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00009891 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00009892}
9893
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009894ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009895Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
9896 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009897 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
9898 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009899 DeclarationName OpName =
9900 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
9901
9902 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
9903 // expression.
9904 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
9905
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009906 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009907 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
9908 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
9909 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009910 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00009911 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009912 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009913 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
9914 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
9915 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009916 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009917
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009918 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
9919 Args, 2,
9920 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009921 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009922 RLoc));
9923 }
9924
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009925 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
9926 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9927 return ExprError();
9928 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9929 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009930
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009931 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009932 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009933
9934 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
9935
9936 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9937 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9938
9939 // Add builtin operator candidates.
9940 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9941
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009942 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9943
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009944 // Perform overload resolution.
9945 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009946 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009947 case OR_Success: {
9948 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9949 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9950
9951 if (FnDecl) {
9952 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9953 // operator.
9954
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009955 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
9956
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009957 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009958 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009959
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009960 // Convert the arguments.
9961 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009962 ExprResult Arg0 =
9963 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9964 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9965 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009966 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009967 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009968
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009969 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009970 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009971 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009972 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009973 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009974 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009975 Owned(Args[1]));
9976 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
9977 return ExprError();
9978
9979 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
9980
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009981 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009982 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9983 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9984 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009985
9986 // Build the actual expression node.
Douglas Gregore9d62932011-07-15 16:25:15 +00009987 DeclarationNameLoc LocInfo;
9988 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = LLoc.getRawEncoding();
9989 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = RLoc.getRawEncoding();
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +00009990 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9991 HadMultipleCandidates,
9992 LLoc, LocInfo);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009993 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9994 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009995
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009996 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9997 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009998 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009999 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010000
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010001 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010002 FnDecl))
10003 return ExprError();
10004
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010005 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010006 } else {
10007 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10008 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10009 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010010 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10011 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10012 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10013 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010014 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010015 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10016
10017 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10018 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10019 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10020 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10021 return ExprError();
10022 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010023
10024 break;
10025 }
10026 }
10027
10028 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010029 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10030 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10031 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10032 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10033 else
10034 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10035 << Args[0]->getType()
10036 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010037 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10038 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010039 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010040 }
10041
10042 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010043 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010044 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010045 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10046 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010047 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
10048 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010049 return ExprError();
10050
10051 case OR_Deleted:
10052 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10053 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010054 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010055 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010056 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
10057 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010058 return ExprError();
10059 }
10060
10061 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010062 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010063}
10064
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010065/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10066/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10067/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10068/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10069/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010070/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10071/// member function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010072ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010073Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10074 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010075 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010076 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10077 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10078
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010079 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10080 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010081 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010082
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010083 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10084 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10085 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10086 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10087
10088 QualType fnType =
10089 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10090
10091 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10092 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10093 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10094
10095 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10096 // member function we're calling.
10097 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10098
10099 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10100 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10101 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10102 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10103
10104 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10105 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10106 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10107 if (difference) {
10108 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10109 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10110 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10111 << qualsString
10112 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10113 }
10114
10115 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
10116 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
10117 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10118
10119 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
10120 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
10121 call, 0))
10122 return ExprError();
10123
10124 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10125 return ExprError();
10126
10127 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10128 }
10129
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010130 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10131 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10132 return ExprError();
10133
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010134 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010135 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010136 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010137 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010138 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10139 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010140 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010141 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010142 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010143 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010144 } else {
10145 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010146 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010147
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010148 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010149 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10150 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10151 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010152
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010153 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010154 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010155
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010156 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10157 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10158 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10159 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10160 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10161 }
10162
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010163 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10164 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10165
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010166 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10167 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10168 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10169 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10170
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010171
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010172 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
Francois Pichet0706d202011-09-17 17:15:52 +000010173 if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010174 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
10175 CandidateSet);
10176 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010177 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10178 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010179 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010180 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010181
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010182 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010183 ObjectClassification,
10184 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010185 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010186 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010187 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010188 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010189 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010190 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010191 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010192 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010193 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010194
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010195 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10196
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010197 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10198
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010199 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010200 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010201 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010202 case OR_Success:
10203 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010204 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010205 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010206 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010207 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010208 break;
10209
10210 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010211 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010212 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010213 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010214 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010215 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010216 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010217
10218 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010219 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010220 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010221 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010222 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010223 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010224
10225 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010226 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010227 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010228 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010229 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010230 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010231 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010232 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010233 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010234 }
10235
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010236 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010237
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010238 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10239 // non-member call based on that function.
10240 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10241 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10242 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10243 }
10244
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010245 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010246 }
10247
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010248 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10249 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10250 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10251
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010252 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010253 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010254 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010255 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010256
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010257 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010258 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010259 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010260 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010261
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010262 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010263 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10264 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010265 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10266 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10267 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10268 FoundDecl, Method);
10269 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10270 return ExprError();
10271 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10272 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010273
10274 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010275 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10276 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010277 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010278 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010279 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010280
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010281 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010282 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010283
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010284 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10285 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10286 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10287 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10288
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010289 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010290 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10291 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10292 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10293 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10294
10295 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruth59259262011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010296 }
Anders Carlsson47061ee2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010297 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010298 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010299}
10300
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010301/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10302/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10303/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10304/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010305ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010306Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010307 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010308 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010309 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010310 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10311 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010312 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010313
10314 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10315 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10316 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010317
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010318 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10319 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010320
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010321 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10322 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010323 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010324 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10325 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10326 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10327 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010328 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010329 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010330
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010331 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +000010332 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010333 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010334 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010335
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010336 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10337 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10338 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10339
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010340 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010341 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010342 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10343 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010344 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010345 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010346
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010347 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010348 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10349 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010350 //
10351 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10352 //
10353 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10354 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010355 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10356 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10357 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10358 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010359 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10360 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10361 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10362 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10363 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010364 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010365 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010366 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010367 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010368 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10369 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10370 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10371 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010372
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010373 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10374 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010375 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010376 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010377
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010378 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010379 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10380 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10381 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10382 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10383 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10384 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010385
Douglas Gregor38b2d3f2011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010386 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10387 {
10388 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
10389 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10390 }
10391 }
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010392 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010393
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010394 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10395
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010396 // Perform overload resolution.
10397 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010398 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010399 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010400 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010401 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
10402 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010403 break;
10404
10405 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010406 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010407 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10408 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
10409 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010410 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010411 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010412 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010413 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010414 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010415 break;
10416
10417 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010418 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010419 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010420 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010421 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010422 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010423
10424 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010425 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010426 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
10427 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010428 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010429 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010430 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010431 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010432 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010433 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010434
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010435 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010436 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010437
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010438 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10439
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010440 if (Best->Function == 0) {
10441 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
10442 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010443 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010444 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
10445 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
10446
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010447 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010448 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010449
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010450 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
10451 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
10452 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010453
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +000010454 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +000010455 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010456 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
10457 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010458 if (Call.isInvalid())
10459 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnarab0cf2972011-11-16 22:46:05 +000010460 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
10461 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
10462 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
10463 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010464
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010465 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010466 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010467 }
10468
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010469 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010470 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010471 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010472
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010473 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
10474 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
10475 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
10476 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010477 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10478 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010479
10480 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
10481 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
10482
10483 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
10484 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
10485 // list).
10486 Expr **MethodArgs;
10487 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
10488 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10489 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
10490 } else {
10491 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
10492 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010493 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010494 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
10495 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010496
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010497 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
10498 HadMultipleCandidates);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010499 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
10500 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010501
10502 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
10503 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010504 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10505 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10506 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10507
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010508 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010509 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010510 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010511 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010512 delete [] MethodArgs;
10513
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010514 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +000010515 Method))
10516 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010517
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010518 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
10519 // slots in the call for them.
10520 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +000010521 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010522 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
10523 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
10524
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010525 bool IsError = false;
10526
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010527 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010528 ExprResult ObjRes =
10529 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
10530 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10531 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
10532 IsError = true;
10533 else
10534 Object = move(ObjRes);
10535 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010536
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010537 // Check the argument types.
10538 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010539 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010540 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010541 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010542
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010543 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010544
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010545 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010546 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010547 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010548 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010549 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010550
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +000010551 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
10552 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010553 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010554 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010555 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
10556 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
10557 IsError = true;
10558 break;
10559 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010560
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000010561 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +000010562 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010563
10564 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
10565 }
10566
10567 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
10568 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
10569 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
10570 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010571 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
10572 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
10573 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010574 }
10575 }
10576
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000010577 if (IsError) return true;
10578
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010579 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +000010580 return true;
10581
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +000010582 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010583}
10584
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010585/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010586/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010587/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010588ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010589Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010590 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
10591 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010592
John McCall4124c492011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010593 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
10594 return ExprError();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010595
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010596 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
10597
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010598 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
10599 //
10600 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
10601 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
10602 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
10603 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010604 DeclarationName OpName =
10605 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010606 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +000010607 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010608
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010609 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +000010610 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
10611 << Base->getSourceRange()))
10612 return ExprError();
10613
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010614 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10615 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
10616 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +000010617
10618 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010619 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010620 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
10621 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010622 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010623
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010624 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10625
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010626 // Perform overload resolution.
10627 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010628 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010629 case OR_Success:
10630 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
10631 break;
10632
10633 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
10634 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10635 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010636 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010637 else
10638 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010639 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010640 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010641 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010642
10643 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010644 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10645 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010646 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010647 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010648
10649 case OR_Deleted:
10650 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10651 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010652 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010653 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010654 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010655 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010656 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010657 }
10658
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010659 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010660 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010661 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010662
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010663 // Convert the object parameter.
10664 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010665 ExprResult BaseResult =
10666 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10667 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10668 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +000010669 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010670 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +000010671
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010672 // Build the operator call.
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010673 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
10674 HadMultipleCandidates);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010675 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10676 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010677
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010678 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10679 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10680 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010681 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010682 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010683 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010684
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010685 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010686 Method))
10687 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +000010688
10689 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +000010690}
10691
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010692/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
10693/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
10694/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
10695/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +000010696/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +000010697Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010698 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010699 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010700 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
10701 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010702 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010703 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010704
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010705 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010706 }
10707
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010708 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010709 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
10710 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010711 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010712 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +000010713 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010714 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010715 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010716 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010717
10718 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +000010719 ICE->getCastKind(),
10720 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000010721 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010722 }
10723
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010724 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010725 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010726 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010727 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10728 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10729 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
10730 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010731 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010732 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
10733 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
10734 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010735 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10736 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010737 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010738 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010739
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010740 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
10741 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
10742 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
10743 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
10744
10745 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
10746 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
10747 // appropriate pointer to member type.
10748 QualType ClassType
10749 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
10750 QualType MemPtrType
10751 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
10752
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010753 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
10754 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10755 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +000010756 }
10757 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010758 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10759 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010760 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010761 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010762
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010763 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010764 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010765 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010766 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010767 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010768
10769 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010770 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10771 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010772 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010773 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10774 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010775 }
10776
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010777 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10778 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010779 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010780 Fn,
10781 ULE->getNameLoc(),
10782 Fn->getType(),
10783 VK_LValue,
10784 Found.getDecl(),
10785 TemplateArgs);
10786 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
10787 return DRE;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010788 }
10789
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010790 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010791 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010792 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10793 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10794 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10795 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10796 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010797
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010798 Expr *Base;
10799
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010800 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
10801 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010802 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
10803 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010804 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10805 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010806 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010807 Fn,
10808 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
10809 Fn->getType(),
10810 VK_LValue,
10811 Found.getDecl(),
10812 TemplateArgs);
10813 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
10814 return DRE;
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000010815 } else {
10816 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
10817 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010818 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman73a04092012-01-07 04:59:52 +000010819 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +000010820 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
10821 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
10822 /*isImplicit=*/true);
10823 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010824 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010825 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010826
John McCall4adb38c2011-04-27 00:36:17 +000010827 ExprValueKind valueKind;
10828 QualType type;
10829 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
10830 valueKind = VK_LValue;
10831 type = Fn->getType();
10832 } else {
10833 valueKind = VK_RValue;
10834 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
10835 }
10836
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010837 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
10838 MemExpr->isArrow(),
10839 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7945c982012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010840 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara635ed24e2011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010841 Fn,
10842 Found,
10843 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
10844 TemplateArgs,
10845 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
10846 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
10847 return ME;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +000010848 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010849
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +000010850 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +000010851}
10852
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010853ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010854 DeclAccessPair Found,
10855 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010856 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +000010857}
10858
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000010859} // end namespace clang